blob: d0475244ba668ccd0a284ab99ef9ef9a3fdccd98 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau41d5e3a2016-08-14 12:25:21 +02007 2016/08/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000581 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200582 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200583 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200584 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - tune.buffers.limit
586 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200587 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200588 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100589 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100590 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200591 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100592 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100593 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100594 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100595 - tune.lua.session-timeout
596 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200597 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100598 - tune.maxaccept
599 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200600 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200601 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200602 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100603 - tune.rcvbuf.client
604 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100605 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100606 - tune.sndbuf.client
607 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100608 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100609 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200610 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100611 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200612 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200613 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200614 - tune.vars.global-max-size
615 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
616 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
617 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100618 - tune.zlib.memlevel
619 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100620
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200621 * Debugging
622 - debug
623 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006263.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627------------------------------------
628
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200629ca-base <dir>
630 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200631 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
632 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634chroot <jail dir>
635 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
636 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
637 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
638 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
639 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
640 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100642cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
643 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
644 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
645 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
647 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
648 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
649 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
650 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
651 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
652 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
653 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
654 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
655 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100656
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200657crt-base <dir>
658 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
659 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
660 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200662daemon
663 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
664 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
665 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
666
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200667deviceatlas-json-file <path>
668 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
669 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
670
671deviceatlas-log-level <value>
672 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
673 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
674
675deviceatlas-separator <char>
676 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
677 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
678
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100679deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200680 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
681 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
682 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100683
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900684external-check
685 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
686 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
687 See "option external-check".
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689gid <number>
690 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
691 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
692 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100693 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
694 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697group <group name>
698 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
699 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100700
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200701log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
703 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100704 configured with "log global".
705
706 <address> can be one of:
707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100708 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100709 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
710 port).
711
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100712 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
713 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
714 port).
715
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100716 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
717 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
718 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
719 writeable).
720
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200721 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
722 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100723
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200724 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
725 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
726 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
727 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
728 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
729 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
730 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
731 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
732 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
733 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
734 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
735
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200736 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
737 one of the following :
738
739 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
740 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
741
742 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
743 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
744
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100745 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746
747 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
748 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
749 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
750
751 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200752 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
753 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
754 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
755 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
756 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
757 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200759 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200760
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100761log-send-hostname [<string>]
762 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
763 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
764 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
765 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
766 the logs.
767
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000768log-tag <string>
769 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
770 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
771 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100772 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000773
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100774lua-load <file>
775 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
776 used multiple times.
777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778nbproc <number>
779 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
780 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
781 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
782 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
783 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
784
785pidfile <pidfile>
786 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
787 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
788 starting the process. See also "daemon".
789
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100790presetenv <name> <value>
791 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
792 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
793 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
794 and "unsetenv".
795
796resetenv [<name> ...]
797 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
798 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
799 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
800 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
801 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
802 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
803 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
804 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
805
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100806stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200807 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
808 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
809 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
810 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
811 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
812 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100813 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200814 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
815 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200816
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200817server-state-base <directory>
818 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200819 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
820 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200821
822server-state-file <file>
823 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
824 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
825 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
826 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
827 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
828 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
829 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
830 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200831 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
832 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200833
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100834setenv <name> <value>
835 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
836 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
837 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
838 and "unsetenv".
839
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100840ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
842 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300843 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100844 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
845 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
846 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
847 "bind" keyword for more information.
848
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100849ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
851 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
852 keyword to see available options.
853
854 Example:
855 global
856 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
857
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100858ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
860 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300861 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100862 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
863 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
864 information.
865
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100866ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
869 keyword to see available options.
870
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200871ssl-dh-param-file <file>
872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
873 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
874 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
875 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
876 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200877 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
878 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
879 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
880 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200881 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
882 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
883 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
884
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100885ssl-server-verify [none|required]
886 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
887 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
888 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
889
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200890stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
891 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
892 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
893 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200894 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
895 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200896
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200897 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
898 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
899 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200900
901stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
902 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
903 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100904 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200905
906stats maxconn <connections>
907 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
908 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
909
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200910uid <number>
911 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
912 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
913 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
914 one. See also "gid" and "user".
915
916ulimit-n <number>
917 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
918 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
919 option.
920
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100921unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
922 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
923
924 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
925 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
926 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
927 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
928 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
929 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
930 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
931 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
932 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
933 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
934
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100935unsetenv [<name> ...]
936 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
937 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
938 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
939 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
940 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
941 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
942 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
943
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944user <user name>
945 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
946 See also "uid" and "group".
947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200948node <name>
949 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
950
951 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
952 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
953 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
954 traffic.
955
956description <text>
957 Add a text that describes the instance.
958
959 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
960 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
961 "<" and ">" characters.
962
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096351degrees-data-file <file path>
964 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
965 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
966
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200967 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100968 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
969
97051degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
971 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
972 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
973 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
974
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200975 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100976 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
977
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100979 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
980 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
981
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200982 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
983 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
984
98551degrees-cache-size <number>
986 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
987 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
988 By default, this cache is disabled.
989
990 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100991 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
992
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009943.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995-----------------------
996
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200997max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
998 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
999 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1000 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1001 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1002 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1003 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1004 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1005 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007maxconn <number>
1008 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1009 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1010 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001011 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1012 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1013 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1014 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001015 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1016 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1017 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1018 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1019 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001021maxconnrate <number>
1022 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1023 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1024 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1025 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1026 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1027 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1028 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1029 fairness.
1030
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001031maxcomprate <number>
1032 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001033 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001034 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1035 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1036 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1037 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1038 default value.
1039
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001040maxcompcpuusage <number>
1041 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1042 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1043 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1044 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1045 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1046 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1047 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1048 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1049
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001050maxpipes <number>
1051 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1052 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1053 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1054 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1055 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1056 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1057
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001058maxsessrate <number>
1059 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1060 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1061 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1062 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1063 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1064 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1065 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1066 fairness.
1067
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001068maxsslconn <number>
1069 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1070 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1071 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1072 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1073 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1074 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1075 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001076 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1077 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1078 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1079 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1080 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1081 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1082 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001083
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001084maxsslrate <number>
1085 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1086 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1087 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1088 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1089 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1090 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1091 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1092 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1093 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1094 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1095
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001096maxzlibmem <number>
1097 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1098 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1099 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001100 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1101 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1102 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104noepoll
1105 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1106 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001107 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108
1109nokqueue
1110 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1111 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1112 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1113
1114nopoll
1115 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1116 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001117 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001118 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001119
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001120nosplice
1121 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1122 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1123 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001124 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001125 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1126 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1127 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1128 "option splice-response".
1129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001130nogetaddrinfo
1131 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1132 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1133
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001134noreuseport
1135 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1136 command line argument "-dR".
1137
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001138spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001139 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1140 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1141 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1142 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1143 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1144 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001145
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001146tune.buffers.limit <number>
1147 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1148 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1149 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1150 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1151 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1152 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1153 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1154 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1155 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1156 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1157 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1158 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1159 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1160 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1161 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1162
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001163tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1164 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1165 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1166 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1167 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1168
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169tune.bufsize <number>
1170 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1171 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1172 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1173 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1174 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1175 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1176 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1177 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001178 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1179 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1180 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001181
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001182tune.chksize <number>
1183 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1184 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1185 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1186 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1187 checks whenever possible.
1188
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001189tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1190 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1191 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1192 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1193 this value. The default value is 1.
1194
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001195tune.http.cookielen <number>
1196 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1197 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1198 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1199 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1200 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1201 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1202 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1203 to change this value.
1204
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001205tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1206 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1207 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1208 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1209 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1210 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1211 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1212 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1213 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1214 limit too high.
1215
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001216tune.idletimer <timeout>
1217 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1218 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1219 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1220 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1221 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1222 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1223 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1224 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1225 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1226
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001227tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1228 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1229 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1230 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1231 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1232 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1233 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1234 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1235
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001236tune.lua.maxmem
1237 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1238 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1239 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1240 memory.
1241
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1243 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001244 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1245 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1246 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001247
1248tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1249 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1250 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1251 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1252 check servers.
1253
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001254tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1255 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1256 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1257 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1258 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1259
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001260tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001261 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1262 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1263 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1264 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1265 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1266 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1267 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1268 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1269 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1270 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001271
1272tune.maxpollevents <number>
1273 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1274 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1275 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1276 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1277 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1278
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001279tune.maxrewrite <number>
1280 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1281 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1282 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1283 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1284 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1285 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1286 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1287 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1288 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1289 bufsize.
1290
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001291tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1292 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1293 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1294 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1295 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1296 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1297 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1298 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1299 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1300 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1301 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1302 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1303 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1304 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1305 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1306 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1307 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1308 setting this parameter to 0.
1309
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001310tune.pipesize <number>
1311 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1312 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1313 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1314 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1315 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1316 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1317
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001318tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1319tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1320 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1321 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1322 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1323 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1324 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1325 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1326 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1327
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001328tune.recv_enough <number>
1329 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1330 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1331 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1332 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1333 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1334
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001335tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1336tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1337 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1338 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1339 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1340 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1341 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1342 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1343 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1344 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1345 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1346 notifying haproxy again.
1347
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001348tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001349 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1350 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1351 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001352 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001353 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1354 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1355 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1356 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1357 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001358 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1359 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001360
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001361tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1362 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1363 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1364 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1365 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1366 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1367 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1368
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001369tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1370 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001371 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001372 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1373 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1374 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1375 being used for too long.
1376
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001377tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1378 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1379 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1380 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1381 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1382 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1383 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1384 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1385 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1386 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1387 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001388 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1389 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001390
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001391tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1392 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1393 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1394 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1395 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1396 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1397 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1398 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001399 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1400 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001401
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001402tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1403 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1404 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1405 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1406 1000 entries.
1407
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001408tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1409tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1410tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1411tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001412 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1413 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1414 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1415 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1416 response processing.
1417 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1418 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1419 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001420
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001421 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1422 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1423 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1424 all available space is consumed.
1425 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1426 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1427 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001428
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001429tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1430 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001431 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001432 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1433 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1434 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1435
1436tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1437 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1438 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1439 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1440 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014423.3. Debugging
1443--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001444
1445debug
1446 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1447 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1448 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1449 system startup.
1450
1451quiet
1452 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1453 line argument "-q".
1454
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014563.4. Userlists
1457--------------
1458It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1459http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1460it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1461
1462userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001463 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001464 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1465
1466group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001467 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1469 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1470
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001471user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1472 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001473 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1474 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001475 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1476 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001477 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001478 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001479
1480
1481 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001482 userlist L1
1483 group G1 users tiger,scott
1484 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001485
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001486 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1487 user scott insecure-password elgato
1488 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001489
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001490 userlist L2
1491 group G1
1492 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001493
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001494 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1495 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1496 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001497
1498 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001499
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001500
15013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001502----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001503It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1504several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1505instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1506values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1507automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1508In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1509using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1510tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1511reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1512Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1513that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1514each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001515
1516peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001517 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001518 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1519
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001520disabled
1521 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1522 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1523 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1524
1525enable
1526 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1527
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001528peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1529 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1530 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1531 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1532 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1533 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1534 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1535
1536 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1537 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1538
1539 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1540 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1541 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1542 across all peers.
1543
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001544 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1545 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001546
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001547 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001548 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001549 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1550 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1551 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001552
1553 backend mybackend
1554 mode tcp
1555 balance roundrobin
1556 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1557 stick on src
1558
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001559 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1560 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001561
1562
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015633.6. Mailers
1564------------
1565It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1566If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1567in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1568
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001569mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001570 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1571 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1572
1573mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1574 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1575
1576 Example:
1577 mailers mymailers
1578 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1579 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1580
1581 backend mybackend
1582 mode tcp
1583 balance roundrobin
1584
1585 email-alert mailers mymailers
1586 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1587 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1588
1589 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1590 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1591
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001592timeout mail <time>
1593 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1594 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1595 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1596 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1597
1598 Example:
1599 mailers mymailers
1600 timeout mail 20s
1601 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016034. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001604----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001607 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001608 - frontend <name>
1609 - backend <name>
1610 - listen <name>
1611
1612A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1613its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1614section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
1617A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1618connections.
1619
1620A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1621to forward incoming connections.
1622
1623A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1624parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1627'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1628case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1629
1630Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1631logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1632proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1633However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1634name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1635
1636Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1637and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001638bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1640modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1641arbitrary criteria.
1642
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001643In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1644a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1645the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1646
1647 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1648 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1649 between responses and new requests.
1650
1651 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1652 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1653 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1654 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1655
1656 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1657 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1658 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1659
1660 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1661 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1662 client-facing connection remains open.
1663
1664 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1665 after the end of the response.
1666
1667The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1668frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1669following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1670weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1671
1672 Backend mode
1673
1674 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1675 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1676 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1677 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1678 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1679 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1680 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1681 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1682 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1683 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1684 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1689--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1692limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1693they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1694limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001695marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001696option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001697and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1698with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1699specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001702 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1703------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1704acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001705appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001706backlog X X X -
1707balance X - X X
1708bind - X X -
1709bind-process X X X X
1710block - X X X
1711capture cookie - X X -
1712capture request header - X X -
1713capture response header - X X -
1714clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001715compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001716contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1717cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001718declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001719default-server X - X X
1720default_backend X X X -
1721description - X X X
1722disabled X X X X
1723dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001724email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001725email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001726email-alert mailers X X X X
1727email-alert myhostname X X X X
1728email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001729enabled X X X X
1730errorfile X X X X
1731errorloc X X X X
1732errorloc302 X X X X
1733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1734errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001735force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001736filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001737fullconn X - X X
1738grace X X X X
1739hash-type X - X X
1740http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001741http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001742http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001743http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001744http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001745http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001746http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001747id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001748ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001749load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001750log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001751log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001752log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001753log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001754max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001755maxconn X X X -
1756mode X X X X
1757monitor fail - X X -
1758monitor-net X X X -
1759monitor-uri X X X -
1760option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1761option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1762option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1763option allbackups (*) X - X X
1764option checkcache (*) X - X X
1765option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1766option contstats (*) X X X -
1767option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1768option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1769option forceclose (*) X X X X
1770-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1771option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001772option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001773option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001774option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001775option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001776option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001777option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001778option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001779option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1780option httpchk X - X X
1781option httpclose (*) X X X X
1782option httplog X X X X
1783option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001784option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001785option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001786option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001787option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1788option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1789option logasap (*) X X X -
1790option mysql-check X - X X
1791option nolinger (*) X X X X
1792option originalto X X X X
1793option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001794option pgsql-check X - X X
1795option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001796option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001797option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001798option smtpchk X - X X
1799option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1800option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1801option splice-request (*) X X X X
1802option splice-response (*) X X X X
1803option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1804option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1805-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001806option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001807option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1808option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1809option tcpka X X X X
1810option tcplog X X X X
1811option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001812external-check command X - X X
1813external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1815rate-limit sessions X X X -
1816redirect - X X X
1817redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1818redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1819reqadd - X X X
1820reqallow - X X X
1821reqdel - X X X
1822reqdeny - X X X
1823reqiallow - X X X
1824reqidel - X X X
1825reqideny - X X X
1826reqipass - X X X
1827reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001828reqitarpit - X X X
1829reqpass - X X X
1830reqrep - X X X
1831-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832reqtarpit - X X X
1833retries X - X X
1834rspadd - X X X
1835rspdel - X X X
1836rspdeny - X X X
1837rspidel - X X X
1838rspideny - X X X
1839rspirep - X X X
1840rsprep - X X X
1841server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001842server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001843source X - X X
1844srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001845stats admin - X X X
1846stats auth X X X X
1847stats enable X X X X
1848stats hide-version X X X X
1849stats http-request - X X X
1850stats realm X X X X
1851stats refresh X X X X
1852stats scope X X X X
1853stats show-desc X X X X
1854stats show-legends X X X X
1855stats show-node X X X X
1856stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1858stick match - - X X
1859stick on - - X X
1860stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001861stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001862stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001863tcp-check connect - - X X
1864tcp-check expect - - X X
1865tcp-check send - - X X
1866tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001867tcp-request connection - X X -
1868tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001869tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001870tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001871tcp-response content - - X X
1872tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001873timeout check X - X X
1874timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001875timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001876timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1877timeout connect X - X X
1878timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1879timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1880timeout http-request X X X X
1881timeout queue X - X X
1882timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001883timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001884timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1885timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001886timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001887transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001888unique-id-format X X X -
1889unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001890use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001891use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001892------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1893 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018964.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1897---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898
1899This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1900
1901
1902acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1903 Declare or complete an access list.
1904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1905 no | yes | yes | yes
1906 Example:
1907 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1908 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1909 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001911 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001912
1913
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001914appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1915 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001916 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1918 no | no | yes | yes
1919 Arguments :
1920 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1921 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1922
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001923 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001924 checked in each cookie value.
1925
1926 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1927 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1928 milliseconds.
1929
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001930 request-learn
1931 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1932 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1933 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1934 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1935 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1936 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1937
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001938 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1939 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1940 data following this prefix.
1941
1942 Example :
1943 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1944
1945 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1946 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1947
1948 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1949 2 modes are currently supported :
1950 - path-parameters :
1951 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1952 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1953 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1954 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1955 - query-string :
1956 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1957 query string.
1958
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001959 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1960 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1961 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001962
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001963 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1964 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965
1966
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001967backlog <conns>
1968 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1970 yes | yes | yes | no
1971 Arguments :
1972 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1973 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001974 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001975
1976 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1977 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1978 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1979 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1980 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1981 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1982 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1983 backlog parameter.
1984
1985 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1986 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1987 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1988
1989 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1990
1991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001993balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1996 yes | no | yes | yes
1997 Arguments :
1998 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1999 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2000 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2001 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2002
2003 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2004 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2005 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2006 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002007 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002008 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002009 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2010 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2011 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2012 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2013 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2014 it, so that you don't worry.
2015
2016 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2017 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2018 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2019 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2020 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2021 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2022 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2023 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002025 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2026 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2027 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2028 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2029 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2030 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2031 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2032 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2033
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002034 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002035 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002036 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2037 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002038 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002039 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2040 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2041 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2042 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2043 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002044 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2045 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2046 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2047 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2048 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2049 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002051 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2052 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2053 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2054 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2055 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2056 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2057 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2058 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002059 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002061 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2062 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2063 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002065 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2066 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2067 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2068 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2069 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2070 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2071 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2072 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2073 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2074 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2075 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2076 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002078 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002079 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2080 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2081 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2082 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2083 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2084 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2085 URIs start with a leading "/".
2086
2087 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2088 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2089 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2090 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002093 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2094
2095 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2097 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002098 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2099 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2100 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2101 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002102 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002103 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2104 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002105
2106 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2107 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2108 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2109 server will receive the request.
2110
2111 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2112 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2113 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2114 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2115 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002116 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2117 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2118 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002120 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2121 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2122 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2123 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2124 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002126 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002127 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2128 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2129 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2130
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002131 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2132 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2133 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2134
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002135 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002136 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002137 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2138 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2139 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2140 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2141 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2142 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002143 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002144 used instead.
2145
2146 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2147 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2148 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2149 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2150
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002151 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2152 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2153 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2154
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002155 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002158 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2159 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002160
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002161 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2162 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2163 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164
2165 Examples :
2166 balance roundrobin
2167 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002168 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002169 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2170 balance hdr(host)
2171 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002172
2173 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2174 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002176 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002177 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2178 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2179 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2180 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2181
2182 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2183 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2184 defaults to 16 kB.
2185
2186 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2187 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2188
2189 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2190 Round Robin.
2191
2192 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2193 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2194 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2195 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2196
2197 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2198
2199 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002200 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002201 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2202 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2203 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002205 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
2207
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002208bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2209bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 no | yes | yes | no
2213 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002214 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2215 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2216 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2217 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002218 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002219 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2220 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2221 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2222 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2223 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2224 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2225 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002226 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2227 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2228 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2229 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2230 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2231 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2232 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002233 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2234 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2235 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002236 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2237 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2238 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002239
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002240 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2241 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002242 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2243 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2244 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002245 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2246 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2247 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2248 the range.
2249
2250 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2251 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2252 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2253 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2254 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2255 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2256 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002257 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002258 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002260 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2261 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2262 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2263 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2264 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2265 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2266 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2267 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2268
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002269 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2270 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2271 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2272 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2275 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2276 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2277 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2278 in a frontend.
2279
2280 Example :
2281 listen http_proxy
2282 bind :80,:443
2283 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002284 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002285
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002286 listen http_https_proxy
2287 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002288 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002289
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002290 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2291 bind ipv6@:80
2292 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2293 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2294
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002295 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002296 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002297
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002298 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2299 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2300 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2301 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2302 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2303
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002304 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002305 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306
2307
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002308bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002309 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2311 yes | yes | yes | yes
2312 Arguments :
2313 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2314 may be used to override a default value.
2315
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002316 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002317 option may be combined with other numbers.
2318
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002319 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002320 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2321 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2322 missing from all processes.
2323
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002324 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002325 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002326 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2327 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2328 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2329 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002330
2331 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2332 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2333 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2334 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2335 and 'even' instances.
2336
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002337 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2338 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2339 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2340 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002341
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002342 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2343 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2344
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002345 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2346 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2347 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2348
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002349 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2350 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2351
2352 Example :
2353 listen app_ip1
2354 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002355 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002356
2357 listen app_ip2
2358 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002359 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002360
2361 listen management
2362 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002363 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002364
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002365 listen management
2366 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2367 bind-process 1-4
2368
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002369 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002370
2371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372block { if | unless } <condition>
2373 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2375 no | yes | yes | yes
2376
2377 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2378 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002379 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002380 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2382 "block" statements per instance.
2383
2384 Example:
2385 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2386 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2387 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2388 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002390 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
2392
2393capture cookie <name> len <length>
2394 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2396 no | yes | yes | no
2397 Arguments :
2398 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2399 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2400 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2401 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2402 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2403
2404 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2405 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2406 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2407 right if it exceeds <length>.
2408
2409 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2410 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2411 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2412 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2413
2414 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2415 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2416 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2417
2418 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2419 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2420 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002421 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2422 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2423 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425 Example:
2426 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2427
2428 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002429 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430
2431
2432capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002433 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2435 no | yes | yes | no
2436 Arguments :
2437 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002438 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2440 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2441 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2442
2443 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2444 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2445 it exceeds <length>.
2446
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002447 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002448 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2449 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002450 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2451 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2452 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2453 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002454 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002455 environments to find where the request came from.
2456
2457 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2458 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2459 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2460 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002462 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2463 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2464 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2465 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2466 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467
2468 Example:
2469 capture request header Host len 15
2470 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002471 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002473 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002474 about logging.
2475
2476
2477capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002478 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 no | yes | yes | no
2481 Arguments :
2482 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002483 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2485 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2486 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2487
2488 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2489 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2490 it exceeds <length>.
2491
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002492 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2494 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2495 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002496 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2497 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2498 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2499 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002501 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2502 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2503 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2504 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2505 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506
2507 Example:
2508 capture response header Content-length len 9
2509 capture response header Location len 15
2510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002511 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512 about logging.
2513
2514
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002515clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2518 yes | yes | yes | no
2519 Arguments :
2520 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2521 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2522 as explained at the top of this document.
2523
2524 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2525 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2526 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2527 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2528 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2529 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2530 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2531 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002532 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2534 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2535
2536 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2537 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2538 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2539 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2540 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2541 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2542
2543 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2544 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2545
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002546 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2547 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002549compression algo <algorithm> ...
2550compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002551compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002552 Enable HTTP compression.
2553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2554 yes | yes | yes | yes
2555 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002556 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2557 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2558 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2559
2560 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002561 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2562 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2563 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002564
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002565 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002566 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002567
2568 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2569 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2570 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2571 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2572 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002573 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002574
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002575 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2576 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2577 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2578 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2579 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2580 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2581 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002582 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002583
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002584 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002585 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002586 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2587 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2588 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2589 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2590 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002591
2592 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2593 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2594 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2595 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2596 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002597 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2598 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2599 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2600 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2601 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002602 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2603 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002604
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002605 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002606 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2607 "Accept-Encoding" header
2608 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002609 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002610 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2611 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002612 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2613 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2614 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2615 "multipart"
2616 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2617 header
2618 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2619 and later
2620 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2621 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002622
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002623 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2624 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002625
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002626 Examples :
2627 compression algo gzip
2628 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002630
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002631contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2634 yes | no | yes | yes
2635 Arguments :
2636 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2637 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2638 as explained at the top of this document.
2639
2640 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002641 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002642 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2644 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2645 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2646 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2647
2648 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2649 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2650 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2651 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2652 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2653 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2654
2655 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2656 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2657 instead.
2658
2659 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2660 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2661
2662
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002663cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002664 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2665 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2668 yes | no | yes | yes
2669 Arguments :
2670 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2671 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2672 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2673 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2674 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2675 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2676 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2677 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2678 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2679
2680 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2681 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2682 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2683 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2684 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2685 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002686 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2687 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2688 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2689 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2690 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691
2692 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002693 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002694
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002695 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002696 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2697 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2698 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2699 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2700 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2701 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2702 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2703 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2704 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2705 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
2707 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2708 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2709 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2710 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2711 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2712 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2713 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2714 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2715 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002716 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002717 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2718 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2719 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002721 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2722 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2723 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002724 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2725 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2726 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2727 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002728 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2729 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2730 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731
2732 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2733 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2734 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2735 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2736 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2737 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2738 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2739 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2740 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2741
2742 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2743 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2744 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2745 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2746 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2747 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2748 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2749 persistence cookie in the cache.
2750 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2751
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002752 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2753 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2754 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2755 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2756 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2757 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2758 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2759 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2760 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2761 they logout.
2762
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002763 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2764 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2765 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2766 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2767
2768 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2769 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2770 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2771 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2772 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2773 this attribute.
2774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002775 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002776 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002777 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2778 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2779 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2780 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2781 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2782 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002783
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002784 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2785 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2786 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2787 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2788 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2789 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2790 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2791 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2792 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2793 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2794 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2795 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2796 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2797 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2798 the site.
2799
2800 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2801 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2802 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2803 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2804 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2805 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2806 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2807 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2808 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2809 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2810 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2811 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2812 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2813 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2814 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2815 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2818 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2819 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2820 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002822 Examples :
2823 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2824 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2825 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002826 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002827
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002828 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002830
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002831declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2832 Declares a capture slot.
2833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2834 no | yes | yes | no
2835 Arguments:
2836 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2837
2838 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2839 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2840 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2841 for use in the response.
2842
2843 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002844 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002845 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2846
2847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002848default-server [param*]
2849 Change default options for a server in a backend
2850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2851 yes | no | yes | yes
2852 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002853 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2854 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2855 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2856 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002857
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002858 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002859 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2860
2861 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864default_backend <backend>
2865 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2867 yes | yes | yes | no
2868 Arguments :
2869 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2870
2871 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2872 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2873 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2874 will catch all undetermined requests.
2875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002876 Example :
2877
2878 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2879 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2880 default_backend dynamic
2881
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002882 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002885description <string>
2886 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | yes
2889 Arguments : string
2890
2891 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2892 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2893 it describes.
2894 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2895
2896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897disabled
2898 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2900 yes | yes | yes | yes
2901 Arguments : none
2902
2903 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2904 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2905 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2906 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2907 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2908 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2909 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2910
2911 See also : "enabled"
2912
2913
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002914dispatch <address>:<port>
2915 Set a default server address
2916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2917 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002918 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002919
2920 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2921 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2922 during start-up.
2923
2924 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2925 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2926 possible with normal servers.
2927
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002928 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002929 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2930 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2931 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2932 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2933
2934 See also : "server"
2935
2936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002937enabled
2938 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2940 yes | yes | yes | yes
2941 Arguments : none
2942
2943 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2944 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2945
2946 See also : "disabled"
2947
2948
2949errorfile <code> <file>
2950 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2952 yes | yes | yes | yes
2953 Arguments :
2954 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002955 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2956 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
2958 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002959 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002960 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002961 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2962 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963
2964 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2965 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2966 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2967
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002968 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2971 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2972 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2973 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2974
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002975 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2976 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2977 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2978 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2979 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2980 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2981
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002982 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2983 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2984 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002985 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2987
2988 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2989
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002990 Example :
2991 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002992 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002993 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2994 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2995
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002996
2997errorloc <code> <url>
2998errorloc302 <code> <url>
2999 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3001 yes | yes | yes | yes
3002 Arguments :
3003 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003004 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003005
3006 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3007 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3008 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3009 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3010 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3011
3012 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3013 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3014 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3015
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003016 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003018 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3019 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3020 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3021 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003022 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003023 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3024 request.
3025
3026 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3027
3028
3029errorloc303 <code> <url>
3030 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3032 yes | yes | yes | yes
3033 Arguments :
3034 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3035 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3036
3037 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3038 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3039 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3040 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3041 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3042
3043 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3044 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3045 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3046
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003047 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3048
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003049 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3050 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3051 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3052 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003053 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003054
3055 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3056
3057
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003058email-alert from <emailaddr>
3059 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3060 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3062 yes | yes | yes | yes
3063
3064 Arguments :
3065
3066 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3067
3068 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3069 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3070
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003071 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003072 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3073 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003074
3075
3076email-alert level <level>
3077 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3078 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3080 yes | yes | yes | yes
3081
3082 Arguments :
3083
3084 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3085 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3086 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3087
3088 By default level is alert
3089
3090 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3091 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3092 for the proxy.
3093
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003094 Alerts are sent when :
3095
3096 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3097 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3098 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3099 is notice or lower
3100 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3101 and a health check status update occurs
3102
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003103 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3104 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003105 section 3.6 about mailers.
3106
3107
3108email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3109 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3111 yes | yes | yes | yes
3112
3113 Arguments :
3114
3115 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3116
3117 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3118 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3119
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003120 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3121 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003122
3123
3124email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3125 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3126 mailers.
3127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 yes | yes | yes | yes
3129
3130 Arguments :
3131
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003132 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003133
3134 By default the systems hostname is used.
3135
3136 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3137 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3138 for the proxy.
3139
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003140 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3141 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003142
3143
3144email-alert to <emailaddr>
3145 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3146 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3148 yes | yes | yes | yes
3149
3150 Arguments :
3151
3152 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3153
3154 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3155 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3156
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003157 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003158 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3159
3160
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003161force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3162 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3164 no | yes | yes | yes
3165
3166 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3167 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3168 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3169 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3170 marked down for maintenance operations.
3171
3172 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3173 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3174 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3175 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3176 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3177 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3178 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3179 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3180 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3181
3182 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3183 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3184 is used.
3185
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003186 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003187 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003188
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003189
3190filter <name> [param*]
3191 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3193 no | yes | yes | yes
3194 Arguments :
3195 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3196 referenced in section 9.
3197
3198 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3199 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3200 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3201 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3202
3203 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3204 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3205
3206 Example:
3207 listen
3208 bind *:80
3209
3210 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3211 filter compression
3212 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3213
3214 compression algo gzip
3215 compression offload
3216
3217 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3218
3219 See also : section 9.
3220
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003221
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003222fullconn <conns>
3223 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 yes | no | yes | yes
3226 Arguments :
3227 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3228 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3229
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003230 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003231 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003232 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3234 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3235 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3236 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3237 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003238 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003239
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003240 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3241 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003242 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3243 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3244 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003245
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003246 Example :
3247 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3248 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3249 # connections.
3250 backend dynamic
3251 fullconn 10000
3252 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3253 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3254
3255 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3256
3257
3258grace <time>
3259 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003261 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262 Arguments :
3263 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3264 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3265 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3266
3267 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3268 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003269 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003270 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3271
3272 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3273 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3274 simplify it.
3275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003276
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003277hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003278 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3280 yes | no | yes | yes
3281 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003282 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3283 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003284
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003285 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3286 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3287 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3288 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3289 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3290 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3291 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3292 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3293 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3294 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003295
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003296 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3297 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3298 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3299 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3300 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3301 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3302 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3303 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3304 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3305 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3306 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3307 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3308 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003309 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3310 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003311
3312 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3313
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003314 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003315 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3316 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3317 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003318 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3319 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3320 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003321
3322 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3323 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003324 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3325 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3326 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3327 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3328
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003329 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3330 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3331 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3332 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3333 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3334 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3335 parameter.
3336
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003337 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3338 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3339 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3340 used on strings.
3341
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003342 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3343
3344 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3345 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3346 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3347 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3348 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3349 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3350 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3351 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3352 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3353 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3354 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3355 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003356
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003357 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3358 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3359 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003360
3361 See also : "balance", "server"
3362
3363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364http-check disable-on-404
3365 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003367 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368 Arguments : none
3369
3370 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3371 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3372 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3373 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3374 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3375 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3376 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3377 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003378 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3379 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3380 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3381
3382 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3383
3384
3385http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003386 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003388 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003389 Arguments :
3390 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3391 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003392 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003393 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3394 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3395 details on the supported keywords.
3396
3397 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3398 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3399 with the usual backslash ('\').
3400
3401 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3402 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3403 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3404 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3405 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3406
3407 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003409 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3410 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3411 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3412
3413 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003414 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003415 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3416 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3417 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3418 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3419
3420 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003421 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003422 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3423 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3424 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3425 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3426 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3427 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3428 trace).
3429
3430 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003431 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003432 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3433 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3434 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3435 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3436 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3437 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3438
3439 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3440 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3441 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3442 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3443 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3444 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3445 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3446 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3447
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003448 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3449 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3450 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3451
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003452 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3453 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3454
3455 Examples :
3456 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003457 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003458
3459 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003460 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003461
3462 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003463 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003464
3465 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003466 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003467
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003468 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003469
3470
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003471http-check send-state
3472 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 yes | no | yes | yes
3475 Arguments : none
3476
3477 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3478 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3479 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3480 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3481 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3482
3483 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3484 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3485 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3486 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3487 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003488 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3489 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3490 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3491
3492 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3493 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3494 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3495
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003496 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3497 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3498 checked in multiple backends.
3499
3500 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3501 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3502
3503 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3504 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3505 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3506 one fails.
3507
3508 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3509 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3510 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3511
3512 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3513 server's queue.
3514
3515 Example of a header received by the application server :
3516 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3517 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3518
3519 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3520
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003521http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3522 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003523 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003524 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003525 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003526 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3527 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003528 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3529 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003530 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3531 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3532 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003533 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003534 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003535 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003536 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003537 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003538 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003539 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003540 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003541 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3542
3543 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3544 no | yes | yes | yes
3545
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003546 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3547 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3548 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3549 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3550 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003551
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003552 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3553 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3554 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3555
3556 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003557 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3558 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3559 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3560 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003561
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003562 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3563 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3564 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3565 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3566 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3567 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3568 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3569 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3570 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003571 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003572 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3573 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003574
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003575 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3576 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3577 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3578 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3579 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3580
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003581 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3582 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3583 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003584 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3585 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003586
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003587 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3588 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3589 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3590 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3591 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3592 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3593 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3594 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3595
3596 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3597 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3598 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003599 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3600 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003601
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003602 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3603 <name>.
3604
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003605 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3606 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3607 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3608 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3609 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3610 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3611 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3612 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3613
3614 Example:
3615
3616 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3617
3618 applied to:
3619
3620 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3621
3622 outputs:
3623
3624 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3625
3626 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3627
3628 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3629 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3630 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3631 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3632 header.
3633
3634 Example:
3635
3636 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3637
3638 applied to:
3639
3640 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3641
3642 outputs:
3643
3644 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3645
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003646 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3647 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3648 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3649 it.
3650
3651 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3652 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3653 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3654 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3655 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3656 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3657
3658 Example :
3659 # prepend the host name before the path
3660 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3661
3662 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3663 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3664 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3665 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3666 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3667 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3668 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3669 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3670
3671 Example :
3672 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3673 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3674
3675 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3676 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3677 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3678 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3679 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3680 "set-query".
3681
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003682 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3683 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3684 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3685 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3686 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3687 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3688 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3689 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3690
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003691 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3692 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3693 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3694 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3695 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3696 another equipment.
3697
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003698 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3699 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3700 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3701 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3702 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3703 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3704 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3705 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3706
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003707 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3708 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3709 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3710 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3711 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3712 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3713 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3714 admin privileges.
3715
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003716 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3717 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3718 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3719 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3720 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3721 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3722 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3723 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3724
3725 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3726 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3727 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3728 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3729 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3730 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3731
3732 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3733 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3734 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3735 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3736 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3737 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3738
3739 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3740 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3741 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3742 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3743 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3744 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3745 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3746 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3747 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3748
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003749 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003750 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3751 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3752 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3753 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3754 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3755 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3756 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3757 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3758 request header" for more information.
3759
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003760 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3761 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3762 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3763 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003764 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3765 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003766
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003767 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3768 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3769 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3770 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3771 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3772 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3773 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3774 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3775 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3776 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3777 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3778 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3779
3780 These actions take one or two arguments :
3781 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3782 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3783 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3784 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3785
3786 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3787 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3788 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3789 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3790
3791 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3792 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3793 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3794 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3795 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3796 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3797 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3798 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3799
3800 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3801 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3802 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3803 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3804 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3805
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003806 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3807 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3808 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3809 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3810 continues.
3811
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003812 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3813 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3814 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3815 the actions evaluation continues.
3816
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003817 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3818 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3819 inline.
3820
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003821 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3822 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3823 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3824 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003825 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003826 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003827 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003828 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3829 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003830 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003831 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003832 and '_'.
3833
3834 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3835 followed by some converters.
3836
3837 Example:
3838
3839 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3840
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003841 - set-src <expr> :
3842 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3843 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3844 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3845 source IP for privacy.
3846
3847 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3848 followed by some converters.
3849
3850 Example:
3851
3852 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3853 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3854
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003855 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
3856 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003857
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003858 - set-src-port <expr> :
3859 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3860 expression.
3861
3862 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3863 followed by some converters.
3864
3865 Example:
3866
3867 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3868 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3869
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003870 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
3871 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
3872 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003873
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003874 - set-dst <expr> :
3875 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3876 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3877 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3878 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3879 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3880
3881 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3882 followed by some converters.
3883
3884 Example:
3885
3886 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
3887 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
3888
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003889 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
3890 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
3891
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003892 - set-dst-port <expr> :
3893 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
3894 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3895 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3896
3897 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3898 followed by some converters.
3899
3900 Example:
3901
3902 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
3903 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
3904
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003905 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
3906 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
3907 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
3908
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003909 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3910 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3911 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3912 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3913 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3914 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3915 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3916 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3917 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3918 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3919 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3920 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3921 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3922 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3923 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3924 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3925
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003926 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3927
3928 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3929 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003930 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3931 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3932
3933 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3934 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3935 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3936 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003937
3938 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003939 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3940 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3941 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003942
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003943 http-request allow if nagios
3944 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3945 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3946 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003947
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003948 Example:
3949 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003950 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003951
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003952 Example:
3953 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3954 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003955 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003956 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3957 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3958 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3959 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3960 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3961 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3962
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003963 Example:
3964 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3965 acl add path /addacl
3966 acl del path /delacl
3967
3968 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3969
3970 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3971 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3972
3973 Example:
3974 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3975 acl setmap path /setmap
3976 acl delmap path /delmap
3977
3978 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3979
3980 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3981 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3982
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003983 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3984 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003985
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003986http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003987 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003988 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003989 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3990 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003991 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003992 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3993 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3994 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3995 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003996 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003997 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08003998 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003999 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004000 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004001 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004002 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004003 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004004 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4005
4006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 no | yes | yes | yes
4008
4009 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4010 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4011 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4012 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4013 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4014 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4015
4016 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4017 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4018 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4019 current section.
4020
4021 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4022 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4023 rules are evaluated.
4024
4025 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4026 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4027 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4028 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4029 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4030 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4031 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4032
4033 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4034 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4035 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4036 external users.
4037
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004038 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4039 <name>.
4040
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004041 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4042 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4043 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4044 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4045 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4046 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4047 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4048 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4049
4050 Example:
4051
4052 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4053
4054 applied to:
4055
4056 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4057
4058 outputs:
4059
4060 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4061
4062 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4063
4064 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4065 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4066 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4067 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4068 header.
4069
4070 Example:
4071
4072 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4073
4074 applied to:
4075
4076 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4077
4078 outputs:
4079
4080 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4081
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004082 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4083 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4084 adapted to the new code.
4085
4086 Example:
4087
4088 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4089 http-response set-status 431
4090
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004091 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4092 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4093 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4094 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4095 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4096 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4097 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4098 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4099
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004100 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4101 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4102 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4103 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4104 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4105 another equipment.
4106
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004107 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4108 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4109 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4110 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4111 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4112 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4113 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4114 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4115
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004116 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4117 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4118 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4119 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4120 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4121 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4122 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4123 admin privileges.
4124
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004125 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4126 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4127 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4128 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4129 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4130 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4131 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4132 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4133
4134 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4135 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4136 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4137 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4138 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4139 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4140
4141 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4142 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4143 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4144 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4145 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4146 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4147
4148 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4149 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4150 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4151 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4152 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4153 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4154 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4155 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4156 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4157
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004158 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4159 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4160 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4161 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4162 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4163 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4164 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4165 response header" for more information.
4166
4167 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4168 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4169 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4170 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4171 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004172 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4173 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004174
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004175 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4176 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4177 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4178 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4179 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4180 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4181
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004182 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4183 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4184 inline.
4185
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004186 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4187 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4188 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4189 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004190 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004191 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004192 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004193 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4194 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004195 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004196 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004197 and '_'.
4198
4199 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4200 followed by some converters.
4201
4202 Example:
4203
4204 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4205
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004206 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4207 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4208 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4209 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4210 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4211 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4212 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4213
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004214 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4215 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4216 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4217 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4218 continues.
4219
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004220 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4221 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4222 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4223 the actions evaluation continues.
4224
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004225 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4226 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4227 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4228 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4229 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4230 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4231 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4232 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4233 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4234 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4235 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4236 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4237 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4238 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4239 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4240 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4241
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004242 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4243
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004244 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004245 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4246 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004247 rules.
4248
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004249 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4250 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4251 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4252 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4253
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004254 Example:
4255 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4256
4257 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4258
4259 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4260 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4261
4262 Example:
4263 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4264
4265 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4266
4267 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4268 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4269
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004270 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4271 ACL usage.
4272
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004273
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004274http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4275 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4276
4277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4278 yes | no | yes | yes
4279
4280 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4281 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4282 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4283 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4284 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4285 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4286
4287 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4288
4289 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4290 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4291 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4292 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4293 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4294 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4295 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4296 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4297 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4298 not checking any request past the first one.
4299
4300 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4301 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4302 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4303 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4304 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4305 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4306 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4307
4308 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4309 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4310 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4311 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4312 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4313 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4314 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4315 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4316 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4317 downsides of rare connection failures.
4318
4319 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4320 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4321 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4322 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4323 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4324 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4325 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4326 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4327 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4328 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4329 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4330 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4331
4332 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4333 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4334 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4335 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4336
4337 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4338 and are never shared ;
4339
4340 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4341 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4342 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4343 and are never shared ;
4344
4345 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4346 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4347 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4348
4349 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4350 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4351 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4352
4353 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4354
4355
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004356http-send-name-header [<header>]
4357 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4358
4359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4360 yes | no | yes | yes
4361
4362 Arguments :
4363
4364 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4365
4366 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4367 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4368 is added with the header string proved.
4369
4370 See also : "server"
4371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004372id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004373 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4375 no | yes | yes | yes
4376 Arguments : none
4377
4378 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4379 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4380 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004381
4382
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004383ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4384 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 no | yes | yes | yes
4387
4388 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4389 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4390 and running).
4391
4392 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4393 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4394 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004395 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004396 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4397
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004398 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4399 "unless" condition is met.
4400
4401 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4402
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004403load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4404 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4405 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4406 yes | no | yes | yes
4407
4408 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4409 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4410 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4411 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4412 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4413 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4414 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4415 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4416
4417 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4418 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004419 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004420
4421 Arguments:
4422 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4423 named "server-state-file".
4424
4425 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4426 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4427 name is used as a file name.
4428
4429 none don't load any stat for this backend
4430
4431 Notes:
4432 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4433 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4434 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4435
4436 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4437 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4438
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004439 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004440
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004441 global
4442 stats socket /tmp/socket
4443 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004444
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004445 defaults
4446 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004447
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004448 backend bk
4449 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4450 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004451
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004452
4453 Then one can run :
4454
4455 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4456
4457 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4458
4459 1
4460 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4461 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4462 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4463
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004464 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004465
4466 global
4467 stats socket /tmp/socket
4468 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4469
4470 defaults
4471 load-server-state-from-file local
4472
4473 backend bk
4474 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4475 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4476
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004477
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004478 Then one can run :
4479
4480 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4481
4482 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4483
4484 1
4485 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4486 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4487 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4488
4489 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4490 "show servers state"
4491
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004493log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004494log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004495no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004496 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4498 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004499
4500 Prefix :
4501 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4502 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4503 prefix does not allow arguments.
4504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004505 Arguments :
4506 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4507 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4508 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4509 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4510 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4511 parameter.
4512
4513 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4514 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4515
4516 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4517 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4518 standard syslog port).
4519
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004520 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4521 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4522 standard syslog port).
4523
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004524 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4525 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4526 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4527 appropriately writeable).
4528
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004529 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4530 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004531
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004532 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4533 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4534 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4535 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4536 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4537 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4538 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4539 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4540 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4541 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4542 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4543
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004544 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4545
4546 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4547 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4548 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4549
4550 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4551 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4552 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004553 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4554 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4555 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4556 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4557 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004558
4559 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4560
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004561 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4562 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4563 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004564
4565 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4566 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4567 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4568 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4569
4570 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4571 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004572
4573 Example :
4574 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004575 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4576 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004577 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004578
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004579
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004580log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004581 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4583 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004584
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004585 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4586 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4587 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4588 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4589 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004590
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004591log-format-sd <string>
4592 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4593 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4594 yes | yes | yes | no
4595
4596 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4597 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4598 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4599 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4600 which covers the log format string in depth.
4601
4602 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4603 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4604
4605 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4606 log format to "rfc5424".
4607
4608 Example :
4609 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4610
4611
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004612log-tag <string>
4613 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4614 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4615 yes | yes | yes | yes
4616
4617 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4618 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4619 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4620 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4621 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4622 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4623 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4624 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4625 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004626
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004627max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4628 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4629 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 yes | no | yes | yes
4631
4632 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4633 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4634 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4635 servers.
4636
4637 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4638 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4639 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4640 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4641 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4642 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4643 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4644 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4645 picking a different server.
4646
4647 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4648 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4649 even if they have to be queued.
4650
4651 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4652 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4653
4654
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004655maxconn <conns>
4656 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 yes | yes | yes | no
4659 Arguments :
4660 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4661 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4662 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4663 closes.
4664
4665 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4666 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4667 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4668 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004669 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4670 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4671 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4672 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004673
4674 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4675 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4676 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4677
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004678 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4679
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004680 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4681
4682
4683mode { tcp|http|health }
4684 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4686 yes | yes | yes | yes
4687 Arguments :
4688 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4689 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4690 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4691 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4692
4693 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4694 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4695 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4696 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4697 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4698
4699 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004700 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4701 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4702 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4703 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4704 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4705 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4706 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004707
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004708 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4709 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4710 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004711
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004712 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004713 defaults http_instances
4714 mode http
4715
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004716 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004718
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004719monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004720 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004723 Arguments :
4724 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4725 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004726 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004727 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4728 backend and its backup.
4729
4730 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4731 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4732 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4733 servers in a list of backends.
4734
4735 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4736 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4737 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4738 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4739 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4740 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4741 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004742 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4743 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744
4745 Example:
4746 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004747 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004748 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4749 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4750 monitor-uri /site_alive
4751 monitor fail if site_dead
4752
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004753 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004754
4755
4756monitor-net <source>
4757 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 yes | yes | yes | no
4760 Arguments :
4761 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4762 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4763 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4764 followed by a mask.
4765
4766 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4767 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004768 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004769 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4770
4771 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4772 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4773 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4774 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004775 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4776 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4777 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004778
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004779 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4780 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4781 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4782 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4783 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4784 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004785
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004786 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4787 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004788
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004789 Example :
4790 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4791 frontend www
4792 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4793
4794 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4795
4796
4797monitor-uri <uri>
4798 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | yes | yes | no
4801 Arguments :
4802 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4803 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4804
4805 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4806 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4807 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4808 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4809 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4810 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4811 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4812 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4813
4814 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4815 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4816 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4817 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4818 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4819 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4820
4821 Example :
4822 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4823 frontend www
4824 mode http
4825 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4826
4827 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4828
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004829
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004830option abortonclose
4831no option abortonclose
4832 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 yes | no | yes | yes
4835 Arguments : none
4836
4837 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4838 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4839 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4840 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004841 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004842 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4843 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4844 encountered while delivering the response.
4845
4846 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4847 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4848 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4849 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4850 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4851 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004852 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004853 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004854 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004855 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4856 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4857 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4858
4859 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4860 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4861 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4862 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4863 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4864 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4865 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4866 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004867 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004868
4869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4871
4872 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4873
4874
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004875option accept-invalid-http-request
4876no option accept-invalid-http-request
4877 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4879 yes | yes | yes | no
4880 Arguments : none
4881
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004882 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004883 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4884 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4885 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4886 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4887 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4888 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4889 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004890 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4891 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4892 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4893 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4894 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004895 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004896 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4897 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4898 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004899
4900 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4901 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4902 been confirmed.
4903
4904 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4905 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004906 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4907 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004908 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4909
4910 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4911 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4912
4913 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4914 stats socket.
4915
4916
4917option accept-invalid-http-response
4918no option accept-invalid-http-response
4919 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | no | yes | yes
4922 Arguments : none
4923
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004924 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004925 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4926 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4927 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4928 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4929 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4930 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4931 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004932 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4933 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4934 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004935
4936 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4937 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4938 been confirmed.
4939
4940 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4941 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4942 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4943 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4944
4945 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4946 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4947
4948 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4949 stats socket.
4950
4951
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004952option allbackups
4953no option allbackups
4954 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4956 yes | no | yes | yes
4957 Arguments : none
4958
4959 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4960 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4961 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4962 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4963 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4964 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4965 order between the backup servers anymore.
4966
4967 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4968 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4969
4970 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4971 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4972
4973
4974option checkcache
4975no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004976 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | no | yes | yes
4979 Arguments : none
4980
4981 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4982 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004983 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004984 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4985 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004986 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004987
4988 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004989 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004990 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004991 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4992 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004993 to the client are :
4994 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004995 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004996 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004997 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4998 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4999 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5000 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5001 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5002 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5003 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5004 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5005 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5006 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5007 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5008
5009 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005010 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005011 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005012 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005013 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5014
5015 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5016 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005017 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005018 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5019
5020 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5021 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5022
5023
5024option clitcpka
5025no option clitcpka
5026 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5028 yes | yes | yes | no
5029 Arguments : none
5030
5031 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5032 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5033 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5034 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5035
5036 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5037 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5038 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5039 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5040
5041 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5042 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5043 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5044 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5045 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5046
5047 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5048
5049 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5050 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5051 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5052
5053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5055
5056 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5057
5058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005059option contstats
5060 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | yes | yes | no
5063 Arguments : none
5064
5065 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5066 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5067 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5068 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5069 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5070 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5071 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5072
5073
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005074option dontlog-normal
5075no option dontlog-normal
5076 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5078 yes | yes | yes | no
5079 Arguments : none
5080
5081 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5082 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5083 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5084 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5085 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5086 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5087 logged.
5088
5089 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5090 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5091 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005094 logging.
5095
5096
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005097option dontlognull
5098no option dontlognull
5099 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5101 yes | yes | yes | no
5102 Arguments : none
5103
5104 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5105 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5106 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5107 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5108 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5109 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005110 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5111 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5112 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005113
5114 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5115 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5116 would not be logged.
5117
5118 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5119 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5120
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005121 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5122 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005123
5124
5125option forceclose
5126no option forceclose
5127 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005129 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005130 Arguments : none
5131
5132 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5133 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5134 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5135 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5136 global session times in the logs.
5137
5138 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005139 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005140 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005141
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005142 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5143 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5144 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5145
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005146 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5147 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005148
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5151
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005152 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005153
5154
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005155option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005156 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5158 yes | yes | yes | yes
5159 Arguments :
5160 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5161 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005162 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005163 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005164
5165 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5166 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5167 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5168 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5169 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5170 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5171 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005172 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5173 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5174 possible that the client has already brought one.
5175
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005176 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005177 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005178 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5179 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005180 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5181 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005182
5183 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5184 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5185 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5186 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5187 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5188 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5189 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5190
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005191 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5192 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5193 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5194 are under the control of the end-user.
5195
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005196 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005197 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5198 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005199 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5200 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5201 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005202
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005203 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005204 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5205 frontend www
5206 mode http
5207 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5208
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005209 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5210 backend www
5211 mode http
5212 option forwardfor header X-Client
5213
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005214 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005215 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005216
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005217
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005218option http-buffer-request
5219no option http-buffer-request
5220 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5222 yes | yes | yes | yes
5223 Arguments : none
5224
5225 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5226 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5227 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5228 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5229 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5230 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5231 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5232 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5233 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5234 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5235 default.
5236
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005237 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005238
5239
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005240option http-ignore-probes
5241no option http-ignore-probes
5242 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5244 yes | yes | yes | no
5245 Arguments : none
5246
5247 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5248 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5249 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5250 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5251 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5252 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5253 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5254 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5255 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5256 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5257 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5258 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5259
5260 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5261 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5262 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5263 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5264 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5265 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5266 are often the only way to detect them.
5267
5268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5270
5271 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5272
5273
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005274option http-keep-alive
5275no option http-keep-alive
5276 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | yes | yes | yes
5279 Arguments : none
5280
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005281 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5282 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5283 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5284 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5285 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5286 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5287 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5288
5289 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5290 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005291 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5292 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5293 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5294 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5295 situations where this option may be useful :
5296
5297 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5298 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5299
5300 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5301 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5302
5303 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5304 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5305 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5306 request.
5307
5308 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5309 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005310 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5311 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5312 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005313
5314 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5315 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5316
5317 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5318 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5319 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5320 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5321 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5322 not set.
5323
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005324 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5325 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005326 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005327 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005328
5329 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005330 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5331 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005332
5333
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005334option http-no-delay
5335no option http-no-delay
5336 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 yes | yes | yes | yes
5339 Arguments : none
5340
5341 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5342 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5343 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5344 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5345 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5346 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5347 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5348 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5349 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5350 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5351 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5352 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5353 affected.
5354
5355 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5356 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5357 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5358 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5359 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5360 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5361 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5362 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5363 latency environments.
5364
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005365 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5366
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005367
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005368option http-pretend-keepalive
5369no option http-pretend-keepalive
5370 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5372 yes | yes | yes | yes
5373 Arguments : none
5374
5375 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5376 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5377 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5378 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5379 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5380 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5381 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5382 consider the response complete.
5383
5384 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5385 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5386 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5387 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5388 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5389 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5390
5391 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5392 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5393 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5394 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5395 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5396 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5397 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5398
5399 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5400 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005401 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005402 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5403 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005404
5405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5407
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005408 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5409 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005410
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005411
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005412option http-server-close
5413no option http-server-close
5414 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 yes | yes | yes | yes
5417 Arguments : none
5418
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005419 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5420 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5421 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5422 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5423 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5424 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5425 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5426 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5427 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5428 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5429 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5430 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5431 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5432 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5433 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5434 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005435
5436 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5437 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5438 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5439 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005440 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5441 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005442
5443 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5444 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005445 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5446 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005447 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5448 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005449
5450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5452
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005453 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005454 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5455 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005456
5457
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005458option http-tunnel
5459no option http-tunnel
5460 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5462 yes | yes | yes | yes
5463 Arguments : none
5464
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005465 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5466 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5467 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5468 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5469 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5470 "option http-tunnel".
5471
5472 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005473 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005474 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5475 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5476 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5477 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5478 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5479 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5480 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005481
5482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5484
5485 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5486 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5487 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5488
5489
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005490option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005491no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005492 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | yes | yes | no
5495 Arguments : none
5496
5497 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5498 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5499 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5500 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5501 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5502 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5503 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5504
5505 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5506 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005507 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5508 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5509 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005510
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005511 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5512 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5513 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5514 front of an existing proxy.
5515
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005516 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5517
5518 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5519 http-server-close".
5520
5521
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005522option httpchk
5523option httpchk <uri>
5524option httpchk <method> <uri>
5525option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5526 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5528 yes | no | yes | yes
5529 Arguments :
5530 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5531 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5532 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5533 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5534 ones.
5535
5536 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5537 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5538 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5539
5540 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5541 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5542 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5543 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5544 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5545
5546 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5547 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5548 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5549 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5550 the lack of any response.
5551
5552 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5553
5554 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5555 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5556 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5557
5558 Examples :
5559 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5560 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5561 backend https_relay
5562 mode tcp
5563 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5564 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5565
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005566 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5567 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5568 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005569
5570
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005571option httpclose
5572no option httpclose
5573 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | yes | yes | yes
5576 Arguments : none
5577
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005578 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5579 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5580 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5581 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005582 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005583 "option http-tunnel".
5584
5585 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5586 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5587 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5588 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5589 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5590 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5591 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5592 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005593
5594 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005595 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005596 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5597 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5598 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5599 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5600 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005601
5602 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5603 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005604 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5605 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005606 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5607 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005608
5609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5611
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005612 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5613 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005614
5615
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005616option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005617 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5619 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005620 Arguments :
5621 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5622 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5623 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5624 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5625 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005626
5627 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5628 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5629 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5630 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5631 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5632 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5633 ports.
5634
5635 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5636
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005637 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5638 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005640 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005641
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005642
5643option http_proxy
5644no option http_proxy
5645 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5647 yes | yes | yes | yes
5648 Arguments : none
5649
5650 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5651 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5652 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5653 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5654 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5655
5656 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5657 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005658 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5659 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005660
5661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5663
5664 Example :
5665 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5666 backend direct_forward
5667 option httpclose
5668 option http_proxy
5669
5670 See also : "option httpclose"
5671
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005672
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005673option independent-streams
5674no option independent-streams
5675 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 yes | yes | yes | yes
5678 Arguments : none
5679
5680 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5681 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5682 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5683 receive data or not.
5684
5685 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5686 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5687 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5688 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5689 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5690 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5691 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5692 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5693 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5694 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5695 socket buffers.
5696
5697 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5698 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5699 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5700 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5701 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5702
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005703 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005704 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5705 deprecated.
5706
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005707 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005708
5709
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005710option ldap-check
5711 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 yes | no | yes | yes
5714 Arguments : none
5715
5716 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5717 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5718 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5719 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5720
5721 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5722 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5723
5724 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5725 configure it.
5726
5727 Example :
5728 option ldap-check
5729
5730 See also : "option httpchk"
5731
5732
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005733option external-check
5734 Use external processes for server health checks
5735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 yes | no | yes | yes
5737
5738 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5739 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5740 command".
5741
5742 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5743
5744 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5745
5746
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005747option log-health-checks
5748no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005749 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 yes | no | yes | yes
5752 Arguments : none
5753
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005754 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5755 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5756 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005757
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005758 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5759 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5760 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5761 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5762 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5763
5764 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5765 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005766
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005767 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5768 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5769 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005770
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005771
5772option log-separate-errors
5773no option log-separate-errors
5774 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | yes | yes | no
5777 Arguments : none
5778
5779 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5780 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5781 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5782 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5783 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5784 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5785 provides very important information.
5786
5787 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5788 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5789 error logs.
5790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005791 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005792 logging.
5793
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005794
5795option logasap
5796no option logasap
5797 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | yes | yes | no
5800 Arguments : none
5801
5802 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5803 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5804 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5805 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5806 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5807 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5808 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005809 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005810 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5811 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5812
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005813 Examples :
5814 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5815 mode http
5816 option httplog
5817 option logasap
5818 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5819
5820 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5821 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5822 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5823 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005825 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005826 logging.
5827
5828
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005829option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005830 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005833 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005834 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5835 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005836 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005837
5838 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5839 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5840 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5841 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5842 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5843 in the MySQL table, like this :
5844
5845 USE mysql;
5846 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5847 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5848
5849 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5850 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5851 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5852 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5853 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5854 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5855 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5856 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5857 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5858
5859 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5860 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005861
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005862 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005863
5864 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5865 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5866 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5867 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005868 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5869 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005870
5871 See also: "option httpchk"
5872
5873
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005874option nolinger
5875no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005876 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5878 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005879 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005880
5881 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5882 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5883 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5884 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5885 connections.
5886
5887 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5888 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5889 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5890 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5891 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5892 this too.
5893
5894 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5895 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5896 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5897
5898 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5899 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5900 for servers.
5901
5902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5904
5905
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005906option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5907 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5909 yes | yes | yes | yes
5910 Arguments :
5911 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5912 matching <network>
5913 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5914 header name.
5915
5916 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5917 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5918 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5919 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5920 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5921 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5922 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5923 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5924 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5925 possible that the client has already brought one.
5926
5927 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5928 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5929 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5930 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5931 header and requires different one.
5932
5933 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5934 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5935 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5936 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5937 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5938 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5939 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5940
5941 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5942 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5943 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5944 both are defined.
5945
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005946 Examples :
5947 # Original Destination address
5948 frontend www
5949 mode http
5950 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5951
5952 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5953 backend www
5954 mode http
5955 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5956
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005957 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5958 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005959
5960
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005961option persist
5962no option persist
5963 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5965 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005966 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005967
5968 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5969 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5970 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5971 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5972 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5973 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5974 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5975 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5976 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5977 redirected to another valid server.
5978
5979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5981
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005982 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005983
5984
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005985option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5986 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5988 yes | no | yes | yes
5989 Arguments :
5990 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5991 PostgreSQL server.
5992
5993 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5994 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5995 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5996 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5997
5998 See also: "option httpchk"
5999
6000
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006001option prefer-last-server
6002no option prefer-last-server
6003 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6004 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6005 yes | no | yes | yes
6006 Arguments : none
6007
6008 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6009 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6010 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6011 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6012 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6013 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6014 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6015 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6016 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006017 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6018 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6019 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6020 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6021 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6022 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6023 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006024
6025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6027
6028 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6029
6030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006031option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006032option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006033no option redispatch
6034 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6036 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006037 Arguments :
6038 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6039 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6040 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6041 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6042 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6043 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6044 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6045 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6046 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006048
6049 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6050 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6051 be able to access the service anymore.
6052
6053 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6054 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6055
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006056 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006057 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6058 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006060 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6061 "redisp" keywords.
6062
6063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6065
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006066 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006067
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006068
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006069option redis-check
6070 Use redis health checks for server testing
6071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6072 yes | no | yes | yes
6073 Arguments : none
6074
6075 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6076 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6077 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6078 find the "+PONG" response message.
6079
6080 Example :
6081 option redis-check
6082
6083 See also : "option httpchk"
6084
6085
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006086option smtpchk
6087option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6088 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6090 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006091 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006092 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6093 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6094 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6095
6096 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6097 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6098 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6099
6100 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6101 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6102 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6103 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6104 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6105 dead server.
6106
6107 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6108 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6109 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6110 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6111
6112 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6113 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6114 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6115 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006116 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006117
6118 Example :
6119 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6120
6121 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006124option socket-stats
6125no option socket-stats
6126
6127 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6129 yes | yes | yes | no
6130
6131 Arguments : none
6132
6133
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006134option splice-auto
6135no option splice-auto
6136 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6138 yes | yes | yes | yes
6139 Arguments : none
6140
6141 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6142 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6143 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6144 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006145 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006146 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6147 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6148 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6149 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6150
6151 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6152 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6153 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6154 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6155 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6156 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6157 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6158 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6159 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6160 keyword.
6161
6162 Example :
6163 option splice-auto
6164
6165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6167
6168 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6169 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6170
6171
6172option splice-request
6173no option splice-request
6174 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6176 yes | yes | yes | yes
6177 Arguments : none
6178
6179 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006180 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006181 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6182 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6183 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6184 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6185
6186 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6187
6188 Example :
6189 option splice-request
6190
6191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6193
6194 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6195 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6196
6197
6198option splice-response
6199no option splice-response
6200 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6202 yes | yes | yes | yes
6203 Arguments : none
6204
6205 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006206 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006207 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6208 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6209 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6210 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6211
6212 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6213
6214 Example :
6215 option splice-response
6216
6217 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6218 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6219
6220 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6221 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6222
6223
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006224option srvtcpka
6225no option srvtcpka
6226 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | no | yes | yes
6229 Arguments : none
6230
6231 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6232 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6233 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6234 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6235
6236 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6237 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6238 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6239 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6240
6241 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6242 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6243 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6244 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6245 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6246
6247 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6248
6249 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6250 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6251 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6252
6253 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6254 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6255
6256 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6257
6258
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006259option ssl-hello-chk
6260 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6262 yes | no | yes | yes
6263 Arguments : none
6264
6265 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6266 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6267 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6268 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6269 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6270 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6271 hello message.
6272
6273 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6274 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6275 messages, which is appreciable.
6276
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006277 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6278 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6279 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006280
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006281 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6282
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006283
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006284option tcp-check
6285 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6287 yes | no | yes | yes
6288
6289 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6290 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6291
6292 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6293 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6294 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6295
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006296 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006297 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6298 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6299 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6300 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6301 only.
6302
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006303 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006304 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6305 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6306 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6307 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6308
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006309 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006310 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6311 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006312 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006313 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6314 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6315 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6316 the respective protocols.
6317 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6318 analysed.
6319
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006320 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6321 script.
6322
6323 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6324 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6325 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6326 The "comment" is of course optional.
6327
6328
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006329 Examples :
6330 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6331 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006332 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006333
6334 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6335 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006336 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006337
6338 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6339 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006340 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006341 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006342 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006343 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006344 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006345 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006346 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6347 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006348 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006349 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6350 tcp-check expect string +OK
6351
6352 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6353 (send many headers before analyzing)
6354 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006355 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006356 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6357 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6358 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6359 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006360 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006361
6362
6363 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6364
6365
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006366option tcp-smart-accept
6367no option tcp-smart-accept
6368 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6370 yes | yes | yes | no
6371 Arguments : none
6372
6373 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6374 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6375 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6376 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6377 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6378 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6379
6380 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6381 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6382 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6383 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6384
6385 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6386 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6387 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6388 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6389
6390 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6391 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6392 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6393
6394 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6395 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6396 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6397
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006398 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6399
6400
6401option tcp-smart-connect
6402no option tcp-smart-connect
6403 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 yes | no | yes | yes
6406 Arguments : none
6407
6408 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6409 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6410 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6411 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6412 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6413
6414 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6415 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6416 complex.
6417
6418 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6419 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6420 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6421
6422 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6423 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6424
6425 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6426
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006427
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006428option tcpka
6429 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6431 yes | yes | yes | yes
6432 Arguments : none
6433
6434 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6435 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6436 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6437 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6438
6439 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6440 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6441 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6442 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6443
6444 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6445 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6446 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6447 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6448 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6449
6450 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6451
6452 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6453 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6454 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6455 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6456 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6457 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6458 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6459 backends.
6460
6461 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6462
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006463
6464option tcplog
6465 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6467 yes | yes | yes | yes
6468 Arguments : none
6469
6470 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6471 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6472 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6473 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6474 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6475 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6476 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6477 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6478
6479 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006481 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006482
6483
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006484option transparent
6485no option transparent
6486 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006489 Arguments : none
6490
6491 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6492 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6493 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6494 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6495 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6496 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6497 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6498 appropriate server.
6499
6500 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6501 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6502
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006503 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006504 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006505
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006506
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006507external-check command <command>
6508 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6510 yes | no | yes | yes
6511
6512 Arguments :
6513 <command> is the external command to run
6514
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006515 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6516
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006517 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006518
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006519 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6520 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6521 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6522 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6523 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6524 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006525
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006526 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6527
6528 Environment variables :
6529 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6530 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6531
6532 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6533
6534 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6535
6536 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6537 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6538 for a UNIX socket).
6539
6540 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6541
6542 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6543
6544 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6545
6546 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6547
6548 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6549
6550 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6551 socket).
6552
6553 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6554 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6555
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006556 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6557 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6558 failed.
6559
6560 Example :
6561 external-check command /bin/true
6562
6563 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6564
6565
6566external-check path <path>
6567 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6569 yes | no | yes | yes
6570
6571 Arguments :
6572 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6573
6574 The default path is "".
6575
6576 Example :
6577 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6578
6579 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6580 "external-check command"
6581
6582
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006583persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006584persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006585 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | no | yes | yes
6588 Arguments :
6589 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006590 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6591 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006592
6593 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6594 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6595 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6596 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6597 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6598 forwarded to this server.
6599
6600 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6601 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6602 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006603 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006604 a single "listen" section.
6605
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006606 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6607 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6608 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6609
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006610 Example :
6611 listen tse-farm
6612 bind :3389
6613 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6614 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6615 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6616 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6617 persist rdp-cookie
6618 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006619 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006620 balance rdp-cookie
6621 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6622 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6623
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006624 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6625 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006626
6627
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006628rate-limit sessions <rate>
6629 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | yes | yes | no
6632 Arguments :
6633 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6634 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6635
6636 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6637 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6638 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6639 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6640 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6641 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6642
6643 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6644 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6645 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6646 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6647
6648 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6649 listen smtp
6650 mode tcp
6651 bind :25
6652 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006653 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006654
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006655 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6656 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6657 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006658
6659 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6660
6661
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006662redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6663redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6664redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006665 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6667 no | yes | yes | yes
6668
6669 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006670 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006671
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006672 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006673 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006674 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6675 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6676 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006677
6678 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6679 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6680 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6681 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6682 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006683 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6684 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6685 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6686 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006687
6688 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6689 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6690 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6691 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6692 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6693 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006694 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006695 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006696 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6697 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6698 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006699
6700 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006701 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6702 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6703 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006704 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006705 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6706 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6707 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6708 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006709
6710 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6711 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6712
6713 - "drop-query"
6714 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6715 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6716 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6717 with a location-type redirect.
6718
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006719 - "append-slash"
6720 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6721 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6722 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6723 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6724
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006725 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6726 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6727 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6728 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6729 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6730 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6731 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6732
6733 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6734 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6735 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6736 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6737 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6738 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6739 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006740
6741 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6742 acl clear dst_port 80
6743 acl secure dst_port 8080
6744 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006745 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006746 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006747 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6748
6749 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006750 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6751 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6752 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006753 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006754
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006755 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6756 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6757 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6758
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006759 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006760 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006761
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006762 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006763 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6764 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6765 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006767 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006768
6769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006770redisp (deprecated)
6771redispatch (deprecated)
6772 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6774 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006775 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006776
6777 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6778 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6779 be able to access the service anymore.
6780
6781 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6782 redistribute them to a working server.
6783
6784 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6785 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6786 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006788 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6789 "option redispatch" instead.
6790
6791 See also : "option redispatch"
6792
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006793
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006794reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006795 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6797 no | yes | yes | yes
6798 Arguments :
6799 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6800 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006801 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006802
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006803 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6804 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6805
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006806 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6807 the last header of an HTTP request.
6808
6809 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6810 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6811 responses.
6812
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006813 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6814 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6815 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6816
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006817 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6818 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006819
6820
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006821reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6822reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006823 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6825 no | yes | yes | yes
6826 Arguments :
6827 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6828 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6829 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6830 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6831 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6832 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6833 ignores case.
6834
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006835 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6836 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6837
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006838 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6839 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6840 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6841 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006842 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006843
6844 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6845 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6846
6847 Example :
6848 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6849 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6850 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6851
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006852 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6853 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006854
6855
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006856reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6857reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006858 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6860 no | yes | yes | yes
6861 Arguments :
6862 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6863 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6864 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6865 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6866 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6867 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6868
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006869 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6870 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6871
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006872 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6873 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6874 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6875 next servers.
6876
6877 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6878 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6879 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6880
6881 Example :
6882 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6883 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6884 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6885
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006886 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6887 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006888
6889
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006890reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6891reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006892 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6894 no | yes | yes | yes
6895 Arguments :
6896 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6897 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6898 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6899 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6900 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6901 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6902 case.
6903
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006904 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6905 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6906
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006907 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6908 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6909 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6910 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006911 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006912
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006913 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006914 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006915 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006916
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006917 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6918 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6919
6920 Example :
6921 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6922 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6923 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6924
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006925 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6926 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006927
6928
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006929reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6930reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006931 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6933 no | yes | yes | yes
6934 Arguments :
6935 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6936 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6937 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6938 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6939 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6940 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6941 case.
6942
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006943 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6944 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6945
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006946 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6947 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6948 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6949 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6950
6951 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6952 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6953
6954 Example :
6955 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6956 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6957 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6958 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6959
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006960 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6961 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006962
6963
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006964reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6965reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006966 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6968 no | yes | yes | yes
6969 Arguments :
6970 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6971 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6972 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6973 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6974 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6975 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6976
6977 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6978 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6979 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6980 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006981 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006982
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006983 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6984 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6985
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006986 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6987 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6988 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6989
6990 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6991 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6992 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6993 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6994 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6995
6996 Example :
6997 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006998 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006999 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7000 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7001
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007002 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7003 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007004
7005
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007006reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7007reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007008 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7010 no | yes | yes | yes
7011 Arguments :
7012 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7013 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7014 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7015 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7016 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7017 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7018 ignores case.
7019
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007020 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7021 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7022
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007023 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7024 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007025 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7026 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7027 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007028 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7029 not set.
7030
7031 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7032 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7033 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7034 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7035 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7036
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007037 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007038 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7039 # block all others.
7040 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7041 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7042
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007043 # block bad guys
7044 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7045 reqitarpit . if badguys
7046
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007047 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7048 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007049
7050
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007051retries <value>
7052 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7054 yes | no | yes | yes
7055 Arguments :
7056 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7057 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7058 default value is 3.
7059
7060 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7061 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7062 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7063
7064 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007065 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7066 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007067
7068 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7069 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7070
7071 See also : "option redispatch"
7072
7073
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007074rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007075 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7077 no | yes | yes | yes
7078 Arguments :
7079 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7080 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007081 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007082
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007083 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7084 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7085
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007086 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7087 the last header of an HTTP response.
7088
7089 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7090 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7091 responses.
7092
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007093 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7094 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007095
7096
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007097rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7098rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007099 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7101 no | yes | yes | yes
7102 Arguments :
7103 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7104 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7105 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7106 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7107 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7108 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7109 ignores case.
7110
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007111 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7112 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7113
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007114 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7115 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007116 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007117 client.
7118
7119 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7120 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7121 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7122
7123 Example :
7124 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007125 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007126
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007127 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7128 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007129
7130
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007131rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7132rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007133 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7135 no | yes | yes | yes
7136 Arguments :
7137 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7138 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7139 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7140 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7141 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7142 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7143 ignores case.
7144
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007145 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7146 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7147
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007148 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7149 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7150 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7151 case-sensitive.
7152
7153 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007154 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7155 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7156 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007157
7158 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7159 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7160
7161 Example :
7162 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7163 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7164
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007165 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7166 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007167
7168
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007169rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7170rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007171 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7173 no | yes | yes | yes
7174 Arguments :
7175 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7176 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7177 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7178 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7179 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7180 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7181 ignores case.
7182
7183 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7184 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7185 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7186 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007187 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007188
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007189 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7190 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7191
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007192 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7193 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7194 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7195
7196 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7197 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7198 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7199 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7200 are not case-sensitive.
7201
7202 Example :
7203 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7204 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7205
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007206 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7207 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007208
7209
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007210server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007211 Declare a server in a backend
7212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 no | no | yes | yes
7214 Arguments :
7215 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007216 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007217 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007218
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007219 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7220 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7221 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7222 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007223 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7224 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7225 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7226 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7227 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007228 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7229 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7230 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7231 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7232 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7233 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7234 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007235 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007236 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7237 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7238 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007239
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007240 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007241 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7242 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7243 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7244 adding this value to the client's port.
7245
7246 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7247 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007248 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007249
7250 Examples :
7251 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7252 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007253 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007254 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7255 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7256 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007257
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007258 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7259 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7260 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7261 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7262 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7263
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007264 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7265 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007266
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007267server-state-file-name [<file>]
7268 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7269 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7270 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7271 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7272 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7273 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7274
7275 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7276 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7277
7278 global
7279 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7280
7281 backend bk
7282 load-server-state-from-file
7283
7284 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7285 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007286
7287source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007288source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007289source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007290 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7292 yes | no | yes | yes
7293 Arguments :
7294 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7295 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007296
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007297 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007298 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7299 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7300 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7301 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7302 supported prefixes are :
7303 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7304 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7305 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007306 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007307 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7308 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007309
7310 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7311 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007312 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7313 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7314 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007315
7316 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7317 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7318 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7319 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7320 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7321 <addr>.
7322
7323 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7324 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7325 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7326 port.
7327
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007328 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7329 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7330 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7331 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007332 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007333 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7334 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7335 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7336 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7337 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7338 HTTP header.
7339
7340 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7341 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007342 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007343 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7344 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7345 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7346 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7347 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7348 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7349 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7350
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007351 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7352 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7353 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7354 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7355 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7356 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7357
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007358 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7359 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7360 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7361 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7362
7363 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7364 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7365 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7366 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7367 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7368 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7369
7370 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7371 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7372 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7373 there are two methods :
7374
7375 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7376 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7377 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7378 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7379 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7380 of the client ranges may be used.
7381
7382 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7383 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7384 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7385 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7386 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7387 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7388 same session.
7389
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007390 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7391 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7392 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007393 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007394
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007395 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7396
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007397 Examples :
7398 backend private
7399 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7400 source 192.168.1.200
7401
7402 backend transparent_ssl1
7403 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7404 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7405
7406 backend transparent_ssl2
7407 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7408 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7409 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7410
7411 backend transparent_ssl3
7412 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7413 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7414 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7415
7416 backend transparent_smtp
7417 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7418 # with Tproxy version 4.
7419 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7420
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007421 backend transparent_http
7422 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7423 # proxy.
7424 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007426 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007427 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007429
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007430srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7431 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7433 yes | no | yes | yes
7434 Arguments :
7435 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7437 as explained at the top of this document.
7438
7439 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7440 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7441 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7442 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7443 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7444 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7445 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7446
7447 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7448 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7449 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7450 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7451 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007452 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007453 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007454 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007455
7456 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7457 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7458 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7459 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7460 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7461 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7462
7463 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7464 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7465
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007466 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7467 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007468
7469
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007470stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7471 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007473 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007474
7475 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7476 matched.
7477
7478 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7479 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7480
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007481 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7482 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7483 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7484
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007485 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7486 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7487 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7488 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007489
7490 Example :
7491 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7492 backend stats_localhost
7493 stats enable
7494 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7495
7496 Example :
7497 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7498 backend stats_auth
7499 stats enable
7500 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7501 stats admin if TRUE
7502
7503 Example :
7504 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7505 userlist stats-auth
7506 group admin users admin
7507 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7508 group readonly users haproxy
7509 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7510
7511 backend stats_auth
7512 stats enable
7513 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7514 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7515 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7516 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7517
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007518 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7519 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7520 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007521
7522
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007523stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7524 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007526 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007527 Arguments :
7528 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7529
7530 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7531
7532 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7533 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7534 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7535 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7536 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7537 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7538
7539 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7540 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7541 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007542 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007543
7544 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7545 report using "stats scope".
7546
7547 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7548 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7549 unobvious parameters.
7550
7551 Example :
7552 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7553 backend public_www
7554 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7555 stats enable
7556 stats hide-version
7557 stats scope .
7558 stats uri /admin?stats
7559 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7560 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7561 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7562
7563 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7564 backend private_monitoring
7565 stats enable
7566 stats uri /admin?stats
7567 stats refresh 5s
7568
7569 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7570
7571
7572stats enable
7573 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007575 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007576 Arguments : none
7577
7578 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7579 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7580 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7581 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7582 - stats auth : no authentication
7583 - stats scope : no restriction
7584
7585 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7586 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7587 unobvious parameters.
7588
7589 Example :
7590 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7591 backend public_www
7592 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7593 stats enable
7594 stats hide-version
7595 stats scope .
7596 stats uri /admin?stats
7597 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7598 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7599 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7600
7601 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7602 backend private_monitoring
7603 stats enable
7604 stats uri /admin?stats
7605 stats refresh 5s
7606
7607 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7608
7609
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007610stats hide-version
7611 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007613 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007614 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007615
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007616 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7617 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7618 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7619 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7620 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7621 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007623 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7624 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7625 unobvious parameters.
7626
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007627 Example :
7628 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7629 backend public_www
7630 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007631 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007632 stats hide-version
7633 stats scope .
7634 stats uri /admin?stats
7635 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7636 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7637 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007638
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007639 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7640 backend private_monitoring
7641 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007642 stats uri /admin?stats
7643 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007644
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007645 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007646
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007647
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007648stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7649 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7650 Access control for statistics
7651
7652 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 no | no | yes | yes
7654
7655 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7656 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7657 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7658 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7659 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7660 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7661
7662 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7663 instance.
7664
7665 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7666 about ACL usage.
7667
7668
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007669stats realm <realm>
7670 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007672 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007673 Arguments :
7674 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7675 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7676 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7677
7678 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7679 using a backslash ('\').
7680
7681 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7682 only related to authentication.
7683
7684 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7685 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7686 unobvious parameters.
7687
7688 Example :
7689 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7690 backend public_www
7691 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7692 stats enable
7693 stats hide-version
7694 stats scope .
7695 stats uri /admin?stats
7696 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7697 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7698 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7699
7700 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7701 backend private_monitoring
7702 stats enable
7703 stats uri /admin?stats
7704 stats refresh 5s
7705
7706 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7707
7708
7709stats refresh <delay>
7710 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007712 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007713 Arguments :
7714 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7715 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7716 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7717 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7718 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7719 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7720
7721 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7722 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7723 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7724 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7725
7726 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7727 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7728 unobvious parameters.
7729
7730 Example :
7731 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7732 backend public_www
7733 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7734 stats enable
7735 stats hide-version
7736 stats scope .
7737 stats uri /admin?stats
7738 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7739 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7740 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7741
7742 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7743 backend private_monitoring
7744 stats enable
7745 stats uri /admin?stats
7746 stats refresh 5s
7747
7748 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7749
7750
7751stats scope { <name> | "." }
7752 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007754 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007755 Arguments :
7756 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7757 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7758 section in which the statement appears.
7759
7760 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7761 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7762 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7763 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7764 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7765 exists.
7766
7767 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7768 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7769 unobvious parameters.
7770
7771 Example :
7772 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7773 backend public_www
7774 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7775 stats enable
7776 stats hide-version
7777 stats scope .
7778 stats uri /admin?stats
7779 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7780 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7781 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7782
7783 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7784 backend private_monitoring
7785 stats enable
7786 stats uri /admin?stats
7787 stats refresh 5s
7788
7789 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7790
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007791
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007792stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007793 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007795 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007796
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007797 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007798 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7799
7800 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7801 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7802
7803 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7804 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007805 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007806
7807 Example :
7808 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7809 backend private_monitoring
7810 stats enable
7811 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7812 stats uri /admin?stats
7813 stats refresh 5s
7814
7815 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7816 global section.
7817
7818
7819stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007820 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7822 yes | yes | yes | yes
7823 Arguments : none
7824
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007825 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007826 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7827 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7828 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7829 - IP (socket, server)
7830 - cookie (backend, server)
7831
7832 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7833 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007834 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007835
7836 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7837
7838
7839stats show-node [ <name> ]
7840 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007842 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007843 Arguments:
7844 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7845 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7846
7847 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7848 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007849 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007850
7851 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7852 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7853 unobvious parameters.
7854
7855 Example:
7856 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7857 backend private_monitoring
7858 stats enable
7859 stats show-node Europe-1
7860 stats uri /admin?stats
7861 stats refresh 5s
7862
7863 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7864 section.
7865
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007866
7867stats uri <prefix>
7868 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007870 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007871 Arguments :
7872 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7873 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7874 query string.
7875
7876 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7877 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7878 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7879 possible to reach it in the application.
7880
7881 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007882 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007883 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7884 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7885 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7886 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7887
7888 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7889 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7890 an address or a port to statistics only.
7891
7892 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7893 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7894 unobvious parameters.
7895
7896 Example :
7897 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7898 backend public_www
7899 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7900 stats enable
7901 stats hide-version
7902 stats scope .
7903 stats uri /admin?stats
7904 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7905 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7906 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7907
7908 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7909 backend private_monitoring
7910 stats enable
7911 stats uri /admin?stats
7912 stats refresh 5s
7913
7914 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7915
7916
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007917stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7918 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007920 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007921
7922 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007923 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007924 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7925 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7926 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7927
7928 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7929 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7930 the "stick-table" statement.
7931
7932 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7933 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7934 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7935 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7936 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7937
7938 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7939 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7940 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7941 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7942 transformation rules.
7943
7944 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7945 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7946 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7947 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7948 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7949 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7950 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7951
7952 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7953 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7954 ACL based conditions.
7955
7956 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7957 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7958 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7959 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7960
7961 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7962 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7963 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7964 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7965
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007966 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7967 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7968 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7969
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007970 Example :
7971 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7972 # last 30 minutes
7973 backend pop
7974 mode tcp
7975 balance roundrobin
7976 stick store-request src
7977 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7978 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7979 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7980
7981 backend smtp
7982 mode tcp
7983 balance roundrobin
7984 stick match src table pop
7985 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7986 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7987
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007988 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007989 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007990
7991
7992stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7993 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7995 no | no | yes | yes
7996
7997 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7998 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7999 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8000 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8001
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008002 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8003 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8004 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8005
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008006 Examples :
8007 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008008 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008009
8010 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8011 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8012 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8013
8014
8015 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8016 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8017 backend http
8018 mode http
8019 balance roundrobin
8020 stick on src table https
8021 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8022 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8023 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8024
8025 backend https
8026 mode tcp
8027 balance roundrobin
8028 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8029 stick on src
8030 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8031 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8032
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008033 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008034
8035
8036stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8037 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8039 no | no | yes | yes
8040
8041 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008042 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008043 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8044 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8045 server is selected.
8046
8047 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8048 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8049 the "stick-table" statement.
8050
8051 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8052 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8053 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8054 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8055 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8056 address.
8057
8058 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8059 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8060 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8061 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8062 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8063 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8064 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8065 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8066 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8067 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8068
8069 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8070 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8071 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8072 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8073 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8074 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8075 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8076
8077 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8078 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8079 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8080 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8081
8082 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8083 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8084 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8085 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8086 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8087 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008088 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8089 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8090 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8091 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8092 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8093 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008094
8095 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8096 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8097 the request.
8098
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008099 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8100 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8101 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8102
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008103 Example :
8104 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8105 # last 30 minutes
8106 backend pop
8107 mode tcp
8108 balance roundrobin
8109 stick store-request src
8110 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8111 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8112 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8113
8114 backend smtp
8115 mode tcp
8116 balance roundrobin
8117 stick match src table pop
8118 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8119 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8120
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008121 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008122 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008123
8124
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008125stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008126 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8127 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008128 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008130 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008131
8132 Arguments :
8133 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8134 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8135 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8136 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8137
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008138 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8139 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8140 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8141 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8142
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008143 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8144 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8145 instance.
8146
8147 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8148 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8149 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8150 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8151 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8152 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008153 to 32 characters.
8154
8155 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8156 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8157 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008158 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008159 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8160 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008161
8162 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008163 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8164 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008165 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8166 increase.
8167
8168 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008169 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8170 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8171 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008172
8173 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8174 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8175 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8176 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8177 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8178 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8179 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8180 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8181 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8182 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8183 parameter (see below).
8184
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008185 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8186 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8187 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8188 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8189 soft restart.
8190
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008191 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8192 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008193
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008194 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8195 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8196 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8197 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8198 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008199 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008200 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8201 if not expiration delay is specified.
8202
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008203 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8204 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8205 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8206 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008207 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8208 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8209 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8210 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8211 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8212 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8213 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8214 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8215 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8216 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8217 types and their arguments.
8218
8219 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8220 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8221 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8222 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8223
8224 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8225 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8226 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8227 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8228
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008229 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8230 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8231 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8232 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8233 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8234 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8235
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008236 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8237 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8238 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8239 they were received.
8240
8241 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8242 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8243 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8244 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8245 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8246
8247 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8248 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8249 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8250 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8251 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8252
8253 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8254 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8255 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8256
8257 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8258 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8259 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8260 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8261 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8262
8263 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8264 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8265 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8266 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8267 the client side.
8268
8269 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8270 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8271 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8272 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8273 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8274 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8275 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8276
8277 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8278 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8279 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8280 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8281 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8282 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8283 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8284
8285 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8286 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8287 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8288 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8289 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8290 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8291
8292 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8293 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8294 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8295 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8296
8297 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8298 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8299 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8300 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8301 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8302 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8303 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8304 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8305 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8306 recommended for better fairness.
8307
8308 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8309 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8310 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8311 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8312
8313 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8314 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8315 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8316 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8317 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8318 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8319 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8320 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8321 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8322 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008323
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008324 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8325 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008326 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8327 reference it.
8328
8329 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8330 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008331 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8332 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8333 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008334
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008335 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8336 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8337 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8338 something that can be ignored.
8339
8340 Example:
8341 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8342 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8343 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8344 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8345
8346 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008347 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008348
8349
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008350stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008351 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8353 no | no | yes | yes
8354
8355 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008356 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008357 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8358 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8359 server is selected.
8360
8361 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8362 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8363 the "stick-table" statement.
8364
8365 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8366 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8367 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8368 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8369
8370 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8371 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8372 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8373 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8374 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8375 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008376 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008377 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8378 rules.
8379
8380 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8381 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8382 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8383 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8384 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8385 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8386 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8387
8388 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8389 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8390 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8391 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8392
8393 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8394 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8395 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8396 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8397 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8398 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008399 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8400 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8401 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8402 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8403 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8404 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8405 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8406 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8407 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008408
8409 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8410
8411 Example :
8412 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8413 backend https
8414 mode tcp
8415 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008416 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008417 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008418
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008419 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8420 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8421
8422 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8423 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8424 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8425
8426 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8427 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008428
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008429 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8430 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8431 # at offset 44.
8432
8433 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8434 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8435
8436 # Learn on response if server hello.
8437 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008438
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008439 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8440 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8441
8442 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8443 extraction.
8444
8445
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008446tcp-check connect [params*]
8447 Opens a new connection
8448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8449 no | no | yes | yes
8450
8451 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8452 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8453 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8454
8455 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8456 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8457 of the sequence.
8458
8459 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8460 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8461 do.
8462
8463 Parameters :
8464 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8465 use the TCP connection.
8466
8467 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8468 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8469 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8470
8471 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8472
8473 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8474
8475 Examples:
8476 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8477 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8478 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8479 option tcp-check
8480 tcp-check connect
8481 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8482 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8483 tcp-check send \r\n
8484 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8485 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8486 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8487 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8488 tcp-check send \r\n
8489 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8490 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8491
8492 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8493 option tcp-check
8494 tcp-check connect port 110
8495 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8496 tcp-check connect port 143
8497 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8498 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8499
8500 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8501
8502
8503tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8504 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8506 no | no | yes | yes
8507
8508 Arguments :
8509 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8510 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8511 binary.
8512 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8513 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8514 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8515
8516 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8517 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8518 with the usual backslash ('\').
8519 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8520 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8521 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8522 used upper or lower case.
8523
8524
8525 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8526
8527 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8528 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8529 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8530 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8531 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8532 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8533 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8534 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8535
8536 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8537 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8538 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8539 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8540 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8541 expression.
8542
8543 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8544 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8545 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8546 this exact hexadecimal string.
8547 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8548
8549 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8550 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8551 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8552 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8553 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8554 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8555 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8556 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8557 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8558 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8559 the null character.
8560
8561 Examples :
8562 # perform a POP check
8563 option tcp-check
8564 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8565
8566 # perform an IMAP check
8567 option tcp-check
8568 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8569
8570 # look for the redis master server
8571 option tcp-check
8572 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008573 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008574 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8575 tcp-check expect string role:master
8576 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8577 tcp-check expect string +OK
8578
8579
8580 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8581 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8582
8583
8584tcp-check send <data>
8585 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8587 no | no | yes | yes
8588
8589 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8590 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8591
8592 Examples :
8593 # look for the redis master server
8594 option tcp-check
8595 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8596 tcp-check expect string role:master
8597
8598 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8599 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8600
8601
8602tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8603 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8604 tcp health check
8605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8606 no | no | yes | yes
8607
8608 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8609 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8610 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8611 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8612 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8613 hexadecimal string.
8614 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8615
8616 Examples :
8617 # redis check in binary
8618 option tcp-check
8619 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8620 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8621
8622
8623 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8624 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8625
8626
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008627tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8628 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8630 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008631 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008632 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8633 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008634
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008635 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008636
8637 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8638 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008639 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8640 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8641 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8642 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8643 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8644 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008645
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008646 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8647 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8648 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8649 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008650
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008651 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008652 - accept :
8653 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8654 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8655 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008656
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008657 - reject :
8658 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8659 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8660 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8661 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8662 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8663 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8664 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8665 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8666 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8667 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8668 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008669 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008670
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008671 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8672 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8673 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8674 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8675 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8676 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8677 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8678 hosts.
8679
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008680 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8681 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8682 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8683 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8684 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8685 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8686 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8687 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8688
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008689 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8690 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8691 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8692 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8693 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8694 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8695 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8696 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8697 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008698 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8699 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008700
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008701 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008702 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008703 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008704 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008705 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8706 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008707 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008708 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8709 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8710 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8711 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8712 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008714 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008715 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008716 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008717 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8718 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8719 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8720 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008722 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8723 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8724 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8725 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008726
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008727 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8728 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8729 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8730 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8731 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008732 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8733 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8734 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8735 layer7 information is extracted.
8736
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008737 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8738 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8739 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8740 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8741 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008742
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008743 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8744 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8745 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8746 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8747
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008748 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8749 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8750 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8751 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8752 continues.
8753
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008754 - set-src <expr> :
8755 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8756 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8757 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8758 set-src"
8759
8760 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8761 followed by some converters.
8762
8763 Example:
8764
8765 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8766
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008767 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8768 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008769
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008770 - set-src-port <expr> :
8771 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8772 expression.
8773
8774 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8775 followed by some converters.
8776
8777 Example:
8778
8779 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8780
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008781 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8782 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8783 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008784
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008785 - set-dst <expr> :
8786 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8787 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8788 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8789 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8790 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8791
8792 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8793 followed by some converters.
8794
8795 Example:
8796
8797 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8798 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8799
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008800 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
8801 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
8802
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008803 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8804 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8805 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8806 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8807
8808
8809 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8810 followed by some converters.
8811
8812 Example:
8813
8814 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8815
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008816 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
8817 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
8818 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8819
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008820 - "silent-drop" :
8821 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8822 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8823 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8824 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8825 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8826 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8827 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8828 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8829 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8830 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8831 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8832 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8833 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8834 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8835 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8836 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8837
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008838 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8839 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8840 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008841
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008842 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8843 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8844 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008845
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008846 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008847 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008848 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008849
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008850 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8851 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8852 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008853
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008854 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008855 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8856 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008857
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008858 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8859
8860 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8861
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008862 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8863
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008864 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008865
8866
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008867tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8868 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008870 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008871 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008872 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8873 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008874
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008875 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008876
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008877 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8878 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8879 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8880 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8881 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008882
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008883 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8884 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8885 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8886 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008887 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8888 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8889 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8890 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8891 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8892 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008893 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008894 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008896 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8897 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8898 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8899 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008900
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008901 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008902 - accept : the request is accepted
8903 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8904 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008905 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008906 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008907 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008908 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008909 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008910
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008911 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8912 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008913
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008914 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8915 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8916 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8917 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8918 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8919 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008921 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008922 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8923 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008925 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008926 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8927 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8928 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8929 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008930 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8931 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8932 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008933
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008934 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008935 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8936 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8937 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008938
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008939 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008940 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
8941 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008942
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008943 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8944 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8945 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8946 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008947 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008948 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008949 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008950 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8951 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008952 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008953 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8954 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008955
8956 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8957 followed by some converters.
8958
8959 Example:
8960
8961 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8962
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008963 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008964 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8965 # and reject everything else.
8966 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8967 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008968 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008969 tcp-request content reject
8970
8971 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008972 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8973 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8974 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008975 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008976
8977 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8978 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8979 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008980 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008981 tcp-request content reject
8982
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008983 Example:
8984 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8985 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008986 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008987
8988 Example:
8989 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8990 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008991 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008993 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8994 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8995
8996 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008997 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008998 # protecting all our sites
8999 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009000 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9001 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009002 ...
9003 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9004
9005 backend http_dynamic
9006 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009007 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009008 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009009 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9010 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9011 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009012 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009014 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009015
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009016 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9017 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009018
9019
9020tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9021 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009023 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009024 Arguments :
9025 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9026 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9027 as explained at the top of this document.
9028
9029 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9030 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9031 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9032 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9033 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9034
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009035 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9036 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9037 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9038 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9039
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009040 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9041 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009042 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009043 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009044 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9045 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9046 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9047 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009048
9049 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9050 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9051 it pass through unaffected.
9052
9053 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9054 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9055 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009056 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009057 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9058 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009059 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9060 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9061 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009062
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009063 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009064 "timeout client".
9065
9066
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009067tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9068 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9070 no | no | yes | yes
9071 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009072 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9073 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009074
9075 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9076
9077 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9078 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9079 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009080 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9081 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009082
9083 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9084
9085 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9086 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9087 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9088 inserted.
9089
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009090 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009091 - accept :
9092 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9093 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9094 the rules evaluation.
9095
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009096 - close :
9097 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9098 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9099 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9100 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9101 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9102 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009103 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009104 protocols.
9105
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009106 - reject :
9107 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9108 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009109 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009110
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009111 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9112 Sets a variable.
9113
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009114 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9115 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9116 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9117 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9118
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009119 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9120 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9121 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9122 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9123 continues.
9124
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009125 - "silent-drop" :
9126 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9127 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9128 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9129 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9130 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9131 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9132 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9133 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9134 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9135 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9136 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9137 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9138 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9139 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9140 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9141 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9142
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009143 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9144 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9145 for changing the default action to a reject.
9146
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009147 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9148 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9149 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9150 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009151 period.
9152
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009153 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9154 declared inline.
9155
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009156 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9157 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9158 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9159 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009160 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009161 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009162 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009163 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9164 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009165 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009166 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9167 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009168
9169 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9170 followed by some converters.
9171
9172 Example:
9173
9174 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9175
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009176 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9177
9178 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9179
9180
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009181tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9182 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9184 no | yes | yes | no
9185 Arguments :
9186 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9187 below.
9188
9189 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9190
9191 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9192 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9193 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9194 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9195 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9196 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9197 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9198 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9199 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9200 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9201 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9202 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9203 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9204 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9205 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9206 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9207 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9208 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9209 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9210 instead.
9211
9212 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9213 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9214 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9215 rules which may be inserted.
9216
9217 Several types of actions are supported :
9218 - accept : the request is accepted
9219 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9220 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9221 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9222 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9223 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9224 - silent-drop
9225
9226 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9227 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9228 sections for a complete description.
9229
9230 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9231 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9232 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9233
9234 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9235 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9236 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9237 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9238 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9239
9240 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9241 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9242
9243 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9244 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9245 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9246
9247 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9248 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9249 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9250
9251 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9252 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9253 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9254
9255 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9256 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9257 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9258
9259 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9260
9261 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9262
9263
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009264tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9265 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9267 no | no | yes | yes
9268 Arguments :
9269 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9270 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9271 as explained at the top of this document.
9272
9273 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9274
9275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009276timeout check <timeout>
9277 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9278 established.
9279
9280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9281 yes | no | yes | yes
9282 Arguments:
9283 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9284 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9285 as explained at the top of this document.
9286
9287 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9288 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9289 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9290 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009291 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9292 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9293 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009294
9295 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9296 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9297
9298 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9299 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009300 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009301
9302 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9303 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9304 forget about it.
9305
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009306 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9307 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009308
9309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009310timeout client <timeout>
9311timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9312 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9314 yes | yes | yes | no
9315 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009316 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009317 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9318 as explained at the top of this document.
9319
9320 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9321 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9322 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009323 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9324 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9325 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9326 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009327 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9328 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9329 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009330 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009331 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009332 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9333 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009334 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9335 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009336
9337 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9338 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9339 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9340 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9341 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9342 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9343
9344 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9345 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9346 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9347
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009348 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9349 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009350
9351
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009352timeout client-fin <timeout>
9353 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9355 yes | yes | yes | no
9356 Arguments :
9357 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9358 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9359 as explained at the top of this document.
9360
9361 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9362 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9363 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9364 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9365 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9366 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9367 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9368 down in one direction.
9369
9370 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9371 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9372 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9373
9374 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9375
9376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009377timeout connect <timeout>
9378timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9379 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | no | yes | yes
9382 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009383 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009384 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9385 as explained at the top of this document.
9386
9387 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009388 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009389 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009390 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009391 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9392 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009393
9394 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9395 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9396 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9397 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9398 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9399 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9400
9401 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9402 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9403 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9404
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009405 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9406 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009407
9408
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009409timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9410 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9412 yes | yes | yes | yes
9413 Arguments :
9414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9416 as explained at the top of this document.
9417
9418 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9419 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9420 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9421 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9422 once the request has started to present itself.
9423
9424 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9425 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9426 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9427 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9428 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9429
9430 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9431 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9432 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9433 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9434
9435 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9436 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9437 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9438 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9439 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009440 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009441
9442 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9443 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9444 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9445 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9446
9447 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9448
9449
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009450timeout http-request <timeout>
9451 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009453 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009454 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009455 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009456 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9457 as explained at the top of this document.
9458
9459 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9460 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9461 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9462 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9463 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9464 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9465 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009466 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9467 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9468 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9469 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9470 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009471 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9472 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009473
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009474 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9475 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9476 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9477 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9478 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009479 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009480
9481 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9482 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9483 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9484 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9485 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9486
9487 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009488 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9489 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9490 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009491
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009492 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009493 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009494
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009495
9496timeout queue <timeout>
9497 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9499 yes | no | yes | yes
9500 Arguments :
9501 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9502 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9503 as explained at the top of this document.
9504
9505 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9506 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9507 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9508 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9509 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9510
9511 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9512 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9513 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9514 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9515
9516 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9517
9518
9519timeout server <timeout>
9520timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9521 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9523 yes | no | yes | yes
9524 Arguments :
9525 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9526 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9527 as explained at the top of this document.
9528
9529 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9530 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9531 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9532 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9533 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9534 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9535 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9536
9537 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9538 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9539 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9540 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9541 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009542 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009543 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009544 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9545 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9546 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9547 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009548
9549 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9550 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9551 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9552 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9553 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9554 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9555
9556 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9557 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9558 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9559
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009560 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009561
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009562
9563timeout server-fin <timeout>
9564 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9566 yes | no | yes | yes
9567 Arguments :
9568 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9569 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9570 as explained at the top of this document.
9571
9572 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9573 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9574 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9575 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9576 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9577 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9578 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9579 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9580 situations, it should not be needed.
9581
9582 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9583 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9584 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9585
9586 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9587
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009588
9589timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009590 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9592 yes | yes | yes | yes
9593 Arguments :
9594 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9595 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9596 as explained at the top of this document.
9597
9598 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9599 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9600 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9601
9602 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9603 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9604 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9605 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009606 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009607
9608 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9609
9610
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009611timeout tunnel <timeout>
9612 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9614 yes | no | yes | yes
9615 Arguments :
9616 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9617 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9618 as explained at the top of this document.
9619
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009620 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009621 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9622 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9623 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9624 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9625 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9626 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9627 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9628 specified.
9629
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009630 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9631 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9632 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9633 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9634 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9635 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9636 state.
9637
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009638 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9639 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9640 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9641 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9642 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9643
9644 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9645 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9646 forget about it.
9647
9648 Example :
9649 defaults http
9650 option http-server-close
9651 timeout connect 5s
9652 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009653 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009654 timeout server 30s
9655 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9656
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009657 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009658
9659
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009660transparent (deprecated)
9661 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009663 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009664 Arguments : none
9665
9666 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9667 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9668 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9669 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9670 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9671 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9672 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9673 appropriate server.
9674
9675 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9676
9677 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9678 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9679
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009680 See also: "option transparent"
9681
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009682unique-id-format <string>
9683 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9685 yes | yes | yes | no
9686 Arguments :
9687 <string> is a log-format string.
9688
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009689 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9690 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9691 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9692 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009693
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009694 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9695 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9696 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9697 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9698 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9699 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9700 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9701 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009702
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009703 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9704 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009705
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009706 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009707
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009708 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009709
9710 will generate:
9711
9712 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9713
9714 See also: "unique-id-header"
9715
9716unique-id-header <name>
9717 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9719 yes | yes | yes | no
9720 Arguments :
9721 <name> is the name of the header.
9722
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009723 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9724 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009725
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009726 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009727
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009728 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009729 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9730
9731 will generate:
9732
9733 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9734
9735 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009736
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009737use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009738 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9740 no | yes | yes | no
9741 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009742 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9743 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009744
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009745 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9746 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009747
9748 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9749 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9750 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009751 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9752 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9753 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9754 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009755
9756 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9757 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9758 assign the backend.
9759
9760 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9761 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9762 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9763 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9764 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9765 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9766
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009767 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009768 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009769 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9770 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9771 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9772
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009773 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9774 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9775 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9776 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9777 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9778 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9779 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9780 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9781 cannot be forced from the request.
9782
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009783 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009784 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9785 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9786
9787 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9788 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009789
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009790
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009791use-server <server> if <condition>
9792use-server <server> unless <condition>
9793 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9795 no | no | yes | yes
9796 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009797 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009798
9799 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9800
9801 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9802 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9803 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9804
9805 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9806 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9807 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9808 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9809 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9810 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9811 matches will assign the server.
9812
9813 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9814 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9815 with the next rules until one matches.
9816
9817 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9818 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9819 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9820 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9821
9822 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9823 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9824 stripped.
9825
9826 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9827 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9828 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9829 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9830
9831 Example :
9832 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9833 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9834 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9835 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9836 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9837 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9838 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9839 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9840 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9841
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009842 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009843
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009844
98455. Bind and Server options
9846--------------------------
9847
9848The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9849depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9850settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9851written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9852described in this section.
9853
9854
98555.1. Bind options
9856-----------------
9857
9858The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9859as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9860no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9861parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9862while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9863provided immediately after the setting name.
9864
9865The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9866
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009867accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9868 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9869 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9870 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9871 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9872 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9873 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9874 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9875 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9876 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009877 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
9878 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
9879 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009880
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009881accept-proxy
9882 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009883 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9884 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009885 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9886 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9887 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9888 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9889 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9890 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9891 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009892 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9893 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009894
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009895alpn <protocols>
9896 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9897 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9898 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9899 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9900 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9901 initial NPN extension.
9902
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009903backlog <backlog>
9904 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9905 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9906
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009907ecdhe <named curve>
9908 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009909 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9910 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009911
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009912ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009913 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9914 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9915 client's certificate.
9916
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009917ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9919 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9920 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9921 error is ignored.
9922
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009923ca-sign-file <cafile>
9924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9925 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9926 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9927 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9928 'generate-certificates' for details.
9929
9930ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9932 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9933 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9934 'generate-certificates' for details.
9935
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009936ciphers <ciphers>
9937 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9938 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009939 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009940 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9941 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9942
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009943crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9945 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9946 to verify client's certificate.
9947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009948crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009949 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9950 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9951 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9952 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9953 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9954 file.
9955
9956 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9957 are loaded.
9958
9959 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009960 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009961 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9962 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9963 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9964 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9965 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9966 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9967 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009968
9969 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9970 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9971 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9972 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009973 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9974 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009975
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009976 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009977
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009978 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9979 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009980 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009981 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9982 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9983 clients).
9984
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009985 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9986 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9987 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9988 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9989 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9990 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9991 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9992 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9993 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9994 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9995 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9996 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9997 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9998
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009999 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10000 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10001 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10002 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10003 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10004
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010005 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10006 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10007 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10008 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010009
10010 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10011 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10012 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10013 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10014 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10015 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10016 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10017 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10018 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10019
10020 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10021
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010022 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010023 a cert bundle.
10024
10025 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10026 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10027 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10028 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10029 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10030 provide multi-cert support.
10031
10032 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10033
10034 Filename | CN | SAN
10035 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10036 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010037 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010038 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10039 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10040
10041 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10042 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10043 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10044 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
10045 suites.
10046
10047 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10048 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10049
10050 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10051 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10052 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10053
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010054crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10056 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010057 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010058 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010059
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010060crt-list <file>
10061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010062 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
10063 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010064
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010065 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010066
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010067 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10068 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10069 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10070 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10071 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10072 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10073 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10074 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010075
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010076 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010077 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
10078 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010079
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010080defer-accept
10081 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10082 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10083 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10084 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10085 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10086 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10087 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10088 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10089 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10090 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10091 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10092
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010093force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010094 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010095 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010096 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10097 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010098
10099force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010100 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010101 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10102 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010103
10104force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010105 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010106 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10107 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010108
10109force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010110 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010111 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10112 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010113
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010114generate-certificates
10115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10116 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10117 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10118 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10119 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10120 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10121 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10122 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10123 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10124 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10125 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10126
10127 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10128 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10129 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10130 certificate is used many times.
10131
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010132gid <gid>
10133 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10134 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10135 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10136 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10137 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10138
10139group <group>
10140 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10141 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10142 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10143 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10144 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10145
10146id <id>
10147 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10148 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10149 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10150 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10151
10152interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010153 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10154 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10155 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10156 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10157 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10158 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10159 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010160
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010161level <level>
10162 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10163 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10164 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10165 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10166 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10167 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10168 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10169 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10170 counters).
10171 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10172 all counters).
10173
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010174maxconn <maxconn>
10175 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10176 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10177 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10178 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10179 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10180 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10181 eat all memory.
10182
10183mode <mode>
10184 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10185 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10186 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10187 UNIX sockets.
10188
10189mss <maxseg>
10190 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10191 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10192 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10193 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10194 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10195 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10196 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10197 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10198 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10199 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10200 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10201
10202name <name>
10203 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10204 page.
10205
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010206namespace <name>
10207 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10208 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10209 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10210 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10211
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010212nice <nice>
10213 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10214 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10215 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10216 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10217 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10218 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10219 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10220 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10221 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10222 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10223 one for an RDP socket.
10224
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010225no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010227 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010228 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010229 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10230 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010231 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010232
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010233no-tls-tickets
10234 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10235 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10236 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010237 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10238 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010239
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010240no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010242 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010243 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010244 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10245 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10246 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010247
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010248no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010250 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010251 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010252 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10253 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10254 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010255
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010256no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010258 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010259 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010260 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10261 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10262 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010263
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010264npn <protocols>
10265 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10266 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10267 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10268 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010269 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10270 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010271
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010272process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10273 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10274 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10275 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10276 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10277 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10278 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10279 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010280 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10281 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10282 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10283 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10284 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10285 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10286 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010287
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010288ssl
10289 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010290 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010291 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10292 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10293 to deciphered contents.
10294
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010295strict-sni
10296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10297 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10298 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10299 See the "crt" option for more information.
10300
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010301tcp-ut <delay>
10302 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10303 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10304 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10305 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10306 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10307 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10308 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10309 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10310 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10311 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10312 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10313
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010314tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010315 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010316 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10317 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10318 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10319 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10320 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10321 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10322 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010323 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10324 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10325 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010326
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010327tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10328 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10329 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10330 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10331 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10332 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10333 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10334 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10335 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10336 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10337 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10338
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010339transparent
10340 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10341 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10342 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10343 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10344 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10345 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10346 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10347 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10348 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10349 so check for support with your vendor.
10350
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010351v4v6
10352 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10353 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10354 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10355 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010356 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010357
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010358v6only
10359 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10360 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10361 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010362 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10363 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010364
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010365uid <uid>
10366 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10367 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10368 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10369 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10370 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10371
10372user <user>
10373 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10374 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10375 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10376 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10377 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10378
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010379verify [none|optional|required]
10380 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10381 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10382 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10383 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10384 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010385 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10386 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10387 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10388 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010389
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200103905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010391------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010393The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10394which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10395arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10396settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10397after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10398Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10399address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010401 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010402 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010404The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010405
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010406addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010407 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010408 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10409 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10410 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10411 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10412 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010414 Supported in default-server: No
10415
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010416agent-check
10417 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010418 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10419 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10420 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10421 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010422
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010423 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010424 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010425 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10426 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10427 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010428
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010429 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10430 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10431 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10432 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10433 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10434
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010435 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10436 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010437
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010438 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10439 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10440 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010441
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010442 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10443 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10444 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010445
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010446 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10447 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10448 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10449 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10450 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10451 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10452 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010453
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010454 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10455 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010456
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010457 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10458 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10459 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10460 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10461 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10462 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10463 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10464 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10465 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010466
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010467 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10468 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010469 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10470 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10471 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010472 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010473
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010474 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10475 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010476
10477 Supported in default-server: No
10478
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010479agent-send <string>
10480 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10481 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10482 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10483 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10484 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10485
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010486agent-inter <delay>
10487 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10488 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10489
10490 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10491 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10492 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10493 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10494 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10495 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10496 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10497 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10498 of backends use the same servers.
10499
10500 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10501
10502 Supported in default-server: Yes
10503
10504agent-port <port>
10505 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10506
10507 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10508
10509 Supported in default-server: Yes
10510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010511backup
10512 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10513 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10514 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10515 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10516 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10517 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010519 Supported in default-server: No
10520
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010521ca-file <cafile>
10522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10523 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10524 server's certificate.
10525
10526 Supported in default-server: No
10527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010528check
10529 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010530 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10531 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10532 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10533 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10534 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10535 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10536 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010537 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10538 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10539 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010541 Supported in default-server: No
10542
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010543check-send-proxy
10544 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10545 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10546 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10547 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10548 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10549 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10550 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10551
10552 Supported in default-server: No
10553
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010554check-ssl
10555 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10556 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10557 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10558 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010559 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010560 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10561 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10562 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10563 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10564
10565 Supported in default-server: No
10566
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010567ciphers <ciphers>
10568 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010569 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010570 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10571 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10572 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10573 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10574 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10575 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10576
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010577 Supported in default-server: No
10578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010579cookie <value>
10580 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10581 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10582 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10583 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10584 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10585 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10586 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010588 Supported in default-server: No
10589
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010590crl-file <crlfile>
10591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10592 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10593 to verify server's certificate.
10594
10595 Supported in default-server: No
10596
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010597crt <cert>
10598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10599 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10600 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10601 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10602 certificate request.
10603
10604 Supported in default-server: No
10605
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010606disabled
10607 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10608 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10609 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10610 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10611 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10612
10613 Supported in default-server: No
10614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010615error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010616 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10617 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10618 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010620 Supported in default-server: Yes
10621
10622 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010624fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010625 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10626 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10627 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10628
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010629 Supported in default-server: Yes
10630
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010631force-sslv3
10632 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10633 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010634 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10635 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010636
10637 Supported in default-server: No
10638
10639force-tlsv10
10640 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010641 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10642 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010643
10644 Supported in default-server: No
10645
10646force-tlsv11
10647 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010648 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10649 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010650
10651 Supported in default-server: No
10652
10653force-tlsv12
10654 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010655 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10656 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010657
10658 Supported in default-server: No
10659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010660id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010661 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10662 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10663 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010665 Supported in default-server: No
10666
10667inter <delay>
10668fastinter <delay>
10669downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010670 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10671 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10672 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10673 between checks depending on the server state :
10674
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010675 Server state | Interval used
10676 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10677 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10678 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10679 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10680 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10681 or yet unchecked. |
10682 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10683 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10684 | "inter" otherwise.
10685 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010687 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10688 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10689 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10690 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010691 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10692 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10693 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10694 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10695 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010697 Supported in default-server: Yes
10698
10699maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010700 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10701 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10702 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10703 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10704 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10705 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10706 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10707 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010709 Supported in default-server: Yes
10710
10711maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010712 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10713 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10714 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10715 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10716 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10717 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10718 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010720 Supported in default-server: Yes
10721
10722minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010723 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10724 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10725 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10726 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10727 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10728 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010729 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010730 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010732 Supported in default-server: Yes
10733
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010734namespace <name>
10735 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10736 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10737 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10738 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10739
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010740no-ssl-reuse
10741 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10742 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10743 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10744 and for paranoid users.
10745
10746 Supported in default-server: No
10747
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010748no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010749 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10750 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010751 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010752
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010753 Supported in default-server: No
10754
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010755no-tls-tickets
10756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10757 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10758 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010759 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10760 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010761
10762 Supported in default-server: No
10763
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010764no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010765 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010766 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10767 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010768 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10769 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10770 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010771
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010772 Supported in default-server: No
10773
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010774no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010775 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010776 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10777 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010778 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10779 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10780 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010781
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010782 Supported in default-server: No
10783
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010784no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010785 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010786 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10787 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010788 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10789 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10790 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010791
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010792 Supported in default-server: No
10793
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010794non-stick
10795 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10796 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10797 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10798
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010799 Supported in default-server: No
10800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010801observe <mode>
10802 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10803 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10804 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10805 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10806 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10807 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010808 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010810 Supported in default-server: No
10811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010812 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010814on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010815 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10816 Currently, four modes are available:
10817 - fastinter: force fastinter
10818 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10819 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10820 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10821 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010823 Supported in default-server: Yes
10824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010825 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10826
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010827on-marked-down <action>
10828 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10829 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010830 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10831 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10832 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10833 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10834 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10835 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10836 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10837 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010838
10839 Actions are disabled by default
10840
10841 Supported in default-server: Yes
10842
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010843on-marked-up <action>
10844 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10845 Currently one action is available:
10846 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10847 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10848 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10849 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10850 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10851 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10852 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10853 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10854
10855 Actions are disabled by default
10856
10857 Supported in default-server: Yes
10858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010859port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010860 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10861 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10862 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10863 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10864 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10865 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010867 Supported in default-server: Yes
10868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010869redir <prefix>
10870 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10871 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10872 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10873 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10874 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10875 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10876 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10877 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010878 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010879 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10880 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10881 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10882 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10883 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10884
10885 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010887 Supported in default-server: No
10888
10889rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010890 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10891 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10892 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010894 Supported in default-server: Yes
10895
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010896resolve-prefer <family>
10897 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10898 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10899 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10900 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10901
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010902 Default value: ipv6
10903
10904 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010905
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010906 Example:
10907
10908 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010909
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010910resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10911 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10912 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10913 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10914 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10915 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10916 configured network, another address is selected.
10917
10918 Supported in default-server: Yes
10919
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010920 Example:
10921
10922 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010923
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010924resolvers <id>
10925 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10926 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010927 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10928 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10929 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10930 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010931
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010932 Supported in default-server: No
10933
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010934 Example:
10935
10936 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010937
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010938 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010939
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010940send-proxy
10941 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10942 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10943 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10944 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010945 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
10946 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
10947 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
10948 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
10949 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
10950 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
10951 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
10952 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
10953 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
10954 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
10955 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
10956 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010957
10958 Supported in default-server: No
10959
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010960send-proxy-v2
10961 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10962 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10963 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10964 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10965 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10966 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10967 option of the "bind" keyword.
10968
10969 Supported in default-server: No
10970
10971send-proxy-v2-ssl
10972 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10973 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10974 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10975 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10976 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10977 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10978 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10979 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10980
10981 Supported in default-server: No
10982
10983send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10984 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10985 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10986 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10987 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10988 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10989 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10990 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10991 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10992 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10993
10994 Supported in default-server: No
10995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010996slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010997 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10998 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10999 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11000 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11001 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11002 parameters :
11003
11004 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11005 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11006
11007 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11008 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11009 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11010 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11011
11012 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11013 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11014 seen as failed.
11015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011016 Supported in default-server: Yes
11017
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011018sni <expression>
11019 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11020 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11021 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11022 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11023 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11024
11025 Supported in default-server: no
11026
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011027source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011028source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011029source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011030 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11031 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11032 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11033 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11034
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011035 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11036 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11037 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11038 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11039 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11040 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11041 server.
11042
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011043 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11044 specifying the source address without port(s).
11045
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011046 Supported in default-server: No
11047
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011048ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011049 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11050 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11051 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11052 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11053 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11054 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011055 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011056
11057 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011058
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011059tcp-ut <delay>
11060 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11061 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11062 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
11063 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
11064 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11065 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11066 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11067 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11068 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11069 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11070 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11071 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11072 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011074track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011075 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11076 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11077 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11078 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011079 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011081 Supported in default-server: No
11082
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011083verify [none|required]
11084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011085 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11086 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11087 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11088 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011089 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11090 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11091 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011092
11093 Supported in default-server: No
11094
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011095verifyhost <hostname>
11096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11097 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11098 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11099 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11100 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11101 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11102
11103 Supported in default-server: No
11104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011105weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011106 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11107 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11108 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011109 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11110 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11111 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11112 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11113 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11114 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011116 Supported in default-server: Yes
11117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011118
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200111195.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11120-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011121
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011122HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11123using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11124configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011125This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11126can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11127workload.
11128This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11129resolution at run time.
11130Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11131carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11132
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011133Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11134health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11135
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011136
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200111375.3.1. Global overview
11138----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011139
11140As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11141different steps of the process life:
11142
11143 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11144 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11145 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11146
11147 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11148 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11149 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11150
11151A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11152 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11153 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11154 resolution to know this new IP.
11155
11156A few things important to notice:
11157 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11158 first valid response.
11159
11160 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11161 servers return an error.
11162
11163
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200111645.3.2. The resolvers section
11165----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011166
11167This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11168HAProxy.
11169There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11170many name servers.
11171
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011172When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11173uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11174is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11175answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11176
11177When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11178used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11179
11180Two types of behavior can be applied:
11181 1. stop DNS resolution
11182 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11183 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11184 1. ANY query type
11185 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11186 server's parameter
11187 3. remaining family type
11188
11189HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11190 - invalid DNS response packet
11191 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11192 - NX domain
11193 - Query refused by server
11194 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11195
11196HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11197 - no Answer records in the response
11198 - DNS response truncated
11199 - Error in DNS response
11200 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11201 - name server timeout
11202
11203For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11204 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11205 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11206 applied;
11207 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11208 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11209 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11210 stops resolution.
11211
11212
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011213resolvers <resolvers id>
11214 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11215
11216A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11217
11218nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11219 DNS server description:
11220 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11221 <ip> : IP address of the server
11222 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11223
11224hold <status> <period>
11225 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11226 on last resolution <status>
11227 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11228 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11229 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11230 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11231
11232 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11233
11234 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11235 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11236 the healch check.
11237
11238resolve_retries <nb>
11239 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11240 giving up.
11241 Default value: 3
11242
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011243 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11244 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11245 type.
11246
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011247timeout <event> <time>
11248 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11249 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11250 events available are:
11251 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11252 been received.
11253 Default value: 1s
11254 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11255 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11256
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011257 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011258
11259 resolvers mydns
11260 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11261 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11262 resolve_retries 3
11263 timeout retry 1s
11264 hold valid 10s
11265
11266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112676. HTTP header manipulation
11268---------------------------
11269
11270In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11271response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11272request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11273which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011274against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011275
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011276If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11277to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11278but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11279HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11280stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11281because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11282a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11283still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011285This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11286in section 4.2 :
11287
11288 - reqadd <string>
11289 - reqallow <search>
11290 - reqiallow <search>
11291 - reqdel <search>
11292 - reqidel <search>
11293 - reqdeny <search>
11294 - reqideny <search>
11295 - reqpass <search>
11296 - reqipass <search>
11297 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11298 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11299 - reqtarpit <search>
11300 - reqitarpit <search>
11301 - rspadd <string>
11302 - rspdel <search>
11303 - rspidel <search>
11304 - rspdeny <search>
11305 - rspideny <search>
11306 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11307 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11308
11309With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11310is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11311parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11312prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11313Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11314
11315 \t for a tab
11316 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11317 \n for a new line (LF)
11318 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11319 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11320 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11321 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11322 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11323
11324The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11325portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11326above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11327regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
113289 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11329is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11330
11331The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11332after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11333
11334Notes related to these keywords :
11335---------------------------------
11336 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11337 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11338 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11339
11340 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11341 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11342 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11343
11344 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11345 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11346 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11347 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11348 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11349
11350 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11351 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11352 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11353 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11354 useless headers before adding new ones.
11355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011356 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011357 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11358
11359 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11360 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11361 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11362
11363 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11364 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011365 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011366
11367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11369----------------------------------
11370
11371Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11372client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11373The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11374these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11375but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11376data called patterns.
11377
11378
113797.1. ACL basics
11380---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011381
11382The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11383content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11384from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11385simple :
11386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011387 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011388 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011389 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11390 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11393adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011394
11395In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011397 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011398
11399This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11400Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11401and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011402an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11403conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11404as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11405are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011406
11407ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11408'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11409which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11410
11411There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11412performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011414The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11415specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11416this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011417methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11418ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011419
11420Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11421 - boolean
11422 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11423 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11424 - string
11425 - data block
11426
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011427Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11428converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11429would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11430The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11431which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11432
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011433Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11434keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11435fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11436which are summarized in the table below :
11437
11438 +---------------------+-----------------+
11439 | Sample or converter | Default |
11440 | output type | matching method |
11441 +---------------------+-----------------+
11442 | boolean | bool |
11443 +---------------------+-----------------+
11444 | integer | int |
11445 +---------------------+-----------------+
11446 | ip | ip |
11447 +---------------------+-----------------+
11448 | string | str |
11449 +---------------------+-----------------+
11450 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11451 +---------------------+-----------------+
11452
11453Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11454matching method, see below.
11455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011456The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11457 - boolean
11458 - integer or integer range
11459 - IP address / network
11460 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11461 - regular expression
11462 - hex block
11463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011464The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11465
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011466 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11467 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011468 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011469 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011470 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011471 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011472 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11475read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11476if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11477lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11478will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11479beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11480a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11481lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11482exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11483
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011484The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11485parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11486ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11487a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11488check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11489
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011490The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11491socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11492file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011494Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11495loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11496
11497 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11498
11499In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11500the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11501case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11502as well.
11503
11504The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11505sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11506do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11507methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11508is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11509obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11510followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11511default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11512that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11513string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11514
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011515The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11516By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11517string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11518resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11519server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11520waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11521flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11522function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011524There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11525sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11526be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011527
11528 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11529 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011530 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11531 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11532 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11533 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011534
11535 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11536 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011537 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011538
11539 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011540 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011541
11542 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011543 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011544
11545 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11546 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11547
11548 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11549 binary or string samples.
11550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011551 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11552 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011554 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11555 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11556 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011558 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11559 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011561 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11562 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011564 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11565 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011567 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11568 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011569 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011571 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11572 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11573 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011574
11575For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11576request, it is possible to do :
11577
11578 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11579
11580In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11581buffer, one would use the following acl :
11582
11583 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11584
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011585On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11586possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11587
11588 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011590All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11591criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11592method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11593to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11594criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11595the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011597If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011598the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11599For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011601 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11602 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11603 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11604 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011605
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011606
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011607The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11608types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11609combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11610brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11611default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613 +-------------------------------------------------+
11614 | Input sample type |
11615 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011616 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11618 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11619 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011620 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011621 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011622 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011623 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011624 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011625 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011626 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011627 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011628 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011629 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011630 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011631 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011632 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011633 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011634 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011635 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011636 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011637 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011638 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011639 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011640 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011641 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11642 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011644
11645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116467.1.1. Matching booleans
11647------------------------
11648
11649In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11650Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11651When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11652that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11653
11654Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11655return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11656"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11657
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116597.1.2. Matching integers
11660------------------------
11661
11662Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11663enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11664to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11665
11666Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11667matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11668lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011669
11670For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11671unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11672representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11673
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011674As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11675two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11676instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11677ranges and operators.
11678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011679For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011680operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11681Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11682of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011684Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011685
11686 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11687 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11688 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11689 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11690 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011692For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011693
11694 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11695
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011696This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11697
11698 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117017.1.3. Matching strings
11702-----------------------
11703
11704String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11705different forms :
11706
11707 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11708 patterns ;
11709
11710 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11711 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11712
11713 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11714 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11715
11716 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11717 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11718
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011719 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011720 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11721 matches.
11722
11723 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11724 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11725 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011726
11727String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11728exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11729characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11730string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11731to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011732before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011733
11734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117357.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11736---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011737
11738Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11739they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11740possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11741passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11742the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011743the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11744match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011745
11746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117477.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11748-------------------------------------
11749
11750It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11751not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11752a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11753to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11754digits may be used upper or lower case.
11755
11756Example :
11757 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11758 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11759
11760
117617.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11762---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011763
11764IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11765netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11766within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011767host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011768difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11769at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11770does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11771parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011772
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011773The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11774abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11775
11776 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11777 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11778 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11779 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11780 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11781 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11782 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11783 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11784
11785Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11786192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11787
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011788IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11789Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11790trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11791IPv6 patterns.
11792
11793HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11794following situations :
11795 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11796 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11797 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11798 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11799 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11800 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11801 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11802 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11803 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11804 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011806
118077.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11808----------------------------------
11809
11810Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11811combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11812
11813 - AND (implicit)
11814 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11815 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011819 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011821Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11822indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011824For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11825"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11826requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11827is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11828
11829 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11830 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11831 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11832 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11833
11834To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11835and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11836
11837 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11838 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11839 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11840 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11841
11842 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11843 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11844 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11845 use_backend www if host_www
11846
11847It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11848expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11849be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11850the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11851
11852 The following rule :
11853
11854 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11855 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11856
11857 Can also be written that way :
11858
11859 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11860
11861It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11862to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11863simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11864sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11865good use is the following :
11866
11867 With named ACLs :
11868
11869 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11870 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11871 monitor fail if site_dead
11872
11873 With anonymous ACLs :
11874
11875 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11876
11877See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11878
11879
118807.3. Fetching samples
11881---------------------
11882
11883Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11884against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11885sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11886ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11887of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11888available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11889
11890This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11891Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11892compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11893deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11894
11895The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11896matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11897method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11898indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11899
11900As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11901when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11902mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11903the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11904ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11905
11906Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11907multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11908when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11909incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11910are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11911is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11912all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11913
11914Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11915 - name
11916 - name(arg1)
11917 - name(arg1,arg2)
11918
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011919
119207.3.1. Converters
11921-----------------
11922
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011923Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11924of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11925is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11926was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11927has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11928unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11929
11930These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11931sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11932the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11933support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011934
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011935A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11936support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11937supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11938(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11939bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011941The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011942
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011943add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011944 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011945 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011946 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11947 scopes allowed are:
11948 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11949 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11950 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11951 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11952 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011953 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011954
11955and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011956 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011957 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011958 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11959 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11960 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11961 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11962 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11963 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11964 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011965 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011966
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011967base64
11968 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11969 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11970 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11971
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011972bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011973 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011974 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11975 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11976 presence of a flag).
11977
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011978bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11979 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11980 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11981 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11982
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011983cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011984 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11985 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011986
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011987crc32([<avalanche>])
11988 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11989 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11990 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11991 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11992 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11993 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11994 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11995 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11996 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11997 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11998 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11999
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012000da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012001 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12002 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12003 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12004 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012005 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012006 configuration language.
12007
12008 Example:
12009 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012010 bind *:8881
12011 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012012 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012013
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012014debug
12015 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12016 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12017 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12018
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012019div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012020 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12021 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012022 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012023 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12024 scope. The scopes allowed are:
12025 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12026 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12027 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12028 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12029 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012030 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012031
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012032djb2([<avalanche>])
12033 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12034 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12035 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12036 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12037 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12038 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12039 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012040 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12041 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012042
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012043even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012044 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012045 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12046
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012047field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12048 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12049 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12050 list of chars.
12051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012052hex
12053 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12054 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12055 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12056 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012058http_date([<offset>])
12059 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12060 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12061 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12062 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12063 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12064 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012066in_table(<table>)
12067 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12068 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12069 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12070 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12071 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12072
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012073ipmask(<mask>)
12074 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12075 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12076 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12077 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12078
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012079json([<input-code>])
12080 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12081 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012082 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012083 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12084 of errors:
12085 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12086 bytes, ...)
12087 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12088 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12089
12090 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12091 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12092 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12093 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12094 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12095 are :
12096 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12097 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12098 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12099 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12100 error ;
12101 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12102 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12103
12104 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12105 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12106
12107 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012108 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012109 capture request header user-agent len 150
12110 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012111
12112 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12113 GET / HTTP/1.0
12114 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12115
12116 Output log:
12117 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12118
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012119language(<value>[,<default>])
12120 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12121 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12122 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12123 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12124 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12125 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12126 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12127 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12128 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12129 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12130 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12131 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012132
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012133 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012134
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012135 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12136 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012137
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012138 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12139 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12140 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12141 use_backend spanish if es
12142 use_backend french if fr
12143 use_backend english if en
12144 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012145
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012146lower
12147 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12148 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12149 type. The result is of type string.
12150
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012151ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12152 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12153 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12154 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12155 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12156 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12157 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12158
12159 Example :
12160
12161 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12162 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12163 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12164
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012165map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12166map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12167map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12168 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12169 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12170 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12171 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12172 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12173 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12174 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12175 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012176
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012177 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12178 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12179 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012180
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012181 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12182 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012183
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012184 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12185 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12186 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12187 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012188 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12189 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012190 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12191 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12192 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12193 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12194 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12195 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12196 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12197 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012198 | | map_reg | |
12199 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12200 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012201 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12202 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12203 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12204 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12205 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012206
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012207 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12208 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12209 the corresponding match text.
12210
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012211 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12212 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12213 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12214 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12215 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012216
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012217 Example :
12218
12219 # this is a comment and is ignored
12220 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12221 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12222 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12223 | | | `---------- value
12224 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12225 | `---------------------------- key
12226 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12227
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012228mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012229 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12230 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012231 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012232 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12233 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12234 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12235 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12236 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12237 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012238 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012239
12240mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012241 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012242 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12243 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012244 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012245 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12246 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12247 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12248 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12249 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12250 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012251 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012252
12253neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012254 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12255 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12256 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12257 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012258
12259not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012260 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012261 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12262 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12263 absence of a flag).
12264
12265odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012266 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012267 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12268
12269or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012270 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012271 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012272 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12273 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12274 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12275 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12276 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12277 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12278 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012279 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012280
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012281regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012282 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12283 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12284 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12285 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12286 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12287 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12288 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12289 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12290 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12291 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012292 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12293 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12294 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12295 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012296
12297 Example :
12298
12299 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12300 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12301 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12302 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12303
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012304capture-req(<id>)
12305 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12306 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12307
12308 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012309 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12310 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012311
12312capture-res(<id>)
12313 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12314 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12315
12316 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012317 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12318 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012319
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012320sdbm([<avalanche>])
12321 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12322 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12323 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12324 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12325 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12326 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12327 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012328 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12329 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012330
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012331set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012332 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12333 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12334 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12335 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12336 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012337 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012338 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12339 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012340 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12341 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12342
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012343sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012344 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12345 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012346 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012347 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12348 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12349 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12350 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012351 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012352 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12353 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012354 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12355 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012356
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012357table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12360 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12361 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12362 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12363 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12364
12365
12366table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12367 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12368 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12369 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12370 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12371 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12372 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12373
12374table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12375 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12376 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12377 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12378 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12379 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12380
12381table_conn_cur(<table>)
12382 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12383 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12384 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12385 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12386 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12387
12388table_conn_rate(<table>)
12389 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12390 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12391 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12392 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12393 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12394
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012395table_gpt0(<table>)
12396 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12397 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12398 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12399 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12400 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12401
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012402table_gpc0(<table>)
12403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12406 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12407 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12408
12409table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12412 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12413 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12414 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12415 sample fetch keyword.
12416
12417table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12418 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12419 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12420 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12421 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12422 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12423
12424table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12425 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12426 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12427 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12428 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12429 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12430 keyword.
12431
12432table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12433 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12434 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12435 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12436 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12437 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12438
12439table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12440 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12441 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12442 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12443 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12444 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12445 keyword.
12446
12447table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12448 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12449 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12450 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12451 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12452 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12453 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12454 keyword.
12455
12456table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12457 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12458 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12459 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12460 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12461 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12462 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12463 keyword.
12464
12465table_server_id(<table>)
12466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12468 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12469 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12470 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12471 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12472
12473table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12477 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12478 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12479 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12480 keyword.
12481
12482table_sess_rate(<table>)
12483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12486 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12487 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12488 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12489 keyword.
12490
12491table_trackers(<table>)
12492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12494 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12495 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12496 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12497 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12498 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12499 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12500 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12501 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12502
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012503upper
12504 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12505 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12506 type. The result is of type string.
12507
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012508url_dec
12509 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12510 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12511
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012512utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12513 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12514 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12515 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12516 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12517 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12518 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12519
12520 Example :
12521
12522 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12523 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12524 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12525
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012526word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12527 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12528 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12529
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012530wt6([<avalanche>])
12531 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12532 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12533 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12534 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12535 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12536 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12537 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012538 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12539 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012540
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012541xor(<value>)
12542 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012543 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012544 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012545 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12546 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12547 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012548 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012549 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12550 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012551 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12552 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012553
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012554
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200125557.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012556--------------------------------------------
12557
12558A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12559not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12560"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12561The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12562
12563always_false : boolean
12564 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12565 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12566
12567always_true : boolean
12568 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12569 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12570
12571avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012572 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012573 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12574 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12575 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12576 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12577 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12578 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12579 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12580 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12581 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12582 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12583 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12584 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12585 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012587be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012588 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12589 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12590 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12591 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12592 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012594be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12595 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12596 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12597 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12598 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12599 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12600 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012601
12602 Example :
12603 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12604 backend dynamic
12605 mode http
12606 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12607 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012608
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012609bin(<hexa>) : bin
12610 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12611 of the string.
12612
12613bool(<bool>) : bool
12614 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12615 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012617connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12618 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012619 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012620 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12621 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012622
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012623 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012624 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012625 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12626
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012627 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12628 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012629
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012630 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012631 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012632 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012633 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12634 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012635 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012636 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012637
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012638 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12639 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012641 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012642
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012643date([<offset>]) : integer
12644 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12645 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12646 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12647 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012648 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12649
12650 Example :
12651
12652 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12653 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012654
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012655env(<name>) : string
12656 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12657 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12658 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12659 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12660 certain way.
12661
12662 Examples :
12663 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12664 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12665
12666 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12667 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012669fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12670 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012671 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12672 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012673 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12674 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12675 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12676 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12677 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012678
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020012679fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12680 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
12681 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
12682 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
12683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012684fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12685 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12686 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12687 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12688 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12689 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12690 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12691 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12692 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012693
12694 Example :
12695 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12696 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12697 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12698 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12699 frontend mail
12700 bind :25
12701 mode tcp
12702 maxconn 100
12703 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12704 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12705 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12706 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012707
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012708int(<integer>) : signed integer
12709 Returns a signed integer.
12710
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012711ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12712 Returns an ipv4.
12713
12714ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12715 Returns an ipv6.
12716
12717meth(<method>) : method
12718 Returns a method.
12719
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012720nbproc : integer
12721 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12722 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12723 and debugging purposes.
12724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012725nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12726 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12727 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12728 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012729 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12730 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12731 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012732
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012733proc : integer
12734 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12735 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12736 debugging purposes.
12737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012738queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012739 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12740 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12741 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012742 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12743 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12744 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12745 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12746 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12747
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012748rand([<range>]) : integer
12749 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12750 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12751 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12752 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12753 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012755srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12756 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12757 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12758 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12759 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12760 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12761 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12762 methods.
12763
12764srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12765 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12766 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12767 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12768 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12769 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12770 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12771 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12772
12773srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12774 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12775 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012776 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012777 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12778 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12779 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12780 overloading servers).
12781
12782 Example :
12783 # Redirect to a separate back
12784 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12785 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12786 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12787
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012788stopping : boolean
12789 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12790 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12791 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12792
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012793str(<string>) : string
12794 Returns a string.
12795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012796table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12797 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12798 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12799
12800table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12801 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12802 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12803 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12804
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012805var(<var-name>) : undefined
12806 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012807 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12808 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012811 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012812 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12816
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200128177.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012818----------------------------------
12819
12820The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12821closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12822methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12823sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12824TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012825the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12826counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12827"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012828argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12829the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12830this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831
12832be_id : integer
12833 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12834 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12835
12836dst : ip
12837 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12838 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12839 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12840 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12841 RFC 4291.
12842
12843dst_conn : integer
12844 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12845 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12846 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12847 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12848 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12849 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12850 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12851 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012852
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020012853dst_is_local : boolean
12854 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
12855 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
12856 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
12857 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
12858 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
12859 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
12860 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
12861 it only once per connection.
12862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863dst_port : integer
12864 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12865 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12866 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12867 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12868 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12869 an HTTP header.
12870
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020012871fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
12872 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
12873 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
12874 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
12875 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12876 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12877 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12878
12879fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
12880 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
12881 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
12882 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
12883 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12884 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12885 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12886
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070012887fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
12888 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
12889 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
12890 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
12891 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12892
12893fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
12894 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
12895 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
12896 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
12897 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12898
12899fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
12900 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
12901 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12902 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12903 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12904
12905fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
12906 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
12907 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12908 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12909 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12910
12911fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
12912 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
12913 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12914 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12915 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12916
12917fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
12918 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
12919 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12920 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12921 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012923fe_id : integer
12924 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12925 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12926 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12927
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012928sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012929sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12930sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12931sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012932 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12933 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12934 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12935
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012936sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012937sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12938sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12939sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012940 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12941 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12942 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12943
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012944sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012945sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12946sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12947sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012948 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12949 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012950 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12951 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12952 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012953
12954 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12955 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012956 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12957 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12958 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012959 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12960 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12961
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012962sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012963sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12964sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12965sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012966 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12967 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12968
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012969sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012970sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12971sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12972sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012973 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12974 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12975 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12976
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012977sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012978sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12979sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12980sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012981 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12982 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12983 See also src_conn_rate.
12984
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012985sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012986sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12987sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12988sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012989 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012990 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012991
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012992sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12993sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12994sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12995sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12996 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12997 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12998
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012999sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013000sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13001sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13002sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013003 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13004 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13005 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013006 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13007 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13008 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013009
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013010sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013011sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13012sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13013sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013014 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13015 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13016 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13017
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013018sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013019sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13020sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13021sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013022 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13023 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13024 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13025 src_http_err_rate.
13026
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013027sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013028sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13029sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13030sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013031 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13032 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13033 src_http_req_cnt.
13034
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013035sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013036sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13037sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13038sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013039 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13040 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13041 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13042 src_http_req_rate.
13043
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013044sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013045sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13046sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13047sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013048 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013049 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13050 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13051 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13052 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013053
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013054 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13055 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013056 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13057
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013058sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013059sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13060sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13061sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013062 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13063 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13064 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013066sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013067sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13068sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13069sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013070 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13071 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13072 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013074sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013075sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13076sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13077sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013078 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13079 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13080 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13081 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013082 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013083 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013085sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013086sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13087sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13088sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013089 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13090 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13091 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13092 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13093 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013094 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013095
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013096sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013097sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13098sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13099sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013100 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13101 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13102 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013104sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013105sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13106sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13107sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013108 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13109 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013110 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013111 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13112 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013113 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13114 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13115 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117so_id : integer
13118 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13119 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13120 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122src : ip
13123 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13124 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13125 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13126 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013127 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13128 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13129 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13130 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013131
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013132 Example:
13133 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13134 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013136src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13137 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13138 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13139 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013140 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013142src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13143 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13144 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013145 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013146 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13149 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13150 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13151 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13152 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13153 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13154 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013155
13156 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13157 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13158 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13159 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013160 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013161 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13162 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013164src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013165 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013166 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013167 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013168 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013170src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013171 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013172 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13173 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013174 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013176src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13177 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13178 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13179 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013180 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013182src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013183 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013184 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013185 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013186 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013187
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013188src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13189 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13190 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13191 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13192 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013195 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013196 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013197 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13198 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013199 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13200 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13201 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013203src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13204 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13205 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013206 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013207 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013210src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13211 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13212 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13213 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13214 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013215 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13218 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13219 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13220 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013221 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013223src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13224 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13225 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13226 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013227 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013228 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013230src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13231 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13232 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13233 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013234 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013235 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13236 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013237
13238 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013239 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013240 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013241
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013242src_is_local : boolean
13243 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13244 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13245 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13246 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13247 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13248 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13249 once per connection.
13250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013251src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013252 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13253 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13254 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13255 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13256 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013258src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013259 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13260 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13261 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13262 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13263 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013265src_port : integer
13266 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13267 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13268 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13269 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013271src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13272 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013273 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13274 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13275 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013276 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013278src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13279 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13280 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13281 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13282 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013283 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013285src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13286 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13287 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13288 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13289 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13290 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13291 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13292 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13293 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013294
13295 Example :
13296 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13297 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13298 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13299 listen ssh
13300 bind :22
13301 mode tcp
13302 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013303 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013305 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307srv_id : integer
13308 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13309 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13310 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013311
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133127.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013313----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013315The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13316closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13317when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13318usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013319future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013320
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013321ssl_bc : boolean
13322 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13323 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13324 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13325
13326ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13327 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13328 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13329
13330ssl_bc_cipher : string
13331 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13332 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13333
13334ssl_bc_protocol : string
13335 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13336 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13337
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013338ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013339 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013340 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13341 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013342
13343ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13344 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13345 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13346 if session was reused or not.
13347
13348ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13349 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13350 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013352ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13353 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13354 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13355 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13356 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13357 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013359ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13360 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13361 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13362 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13363 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013364
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013365ssl_c_der : binary
13366 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13367 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13368 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370ssl_c_err : integer
13371 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13372 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13373 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13374 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13375 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13378 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13379 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13380 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13381 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13382 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13383 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13384 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13385 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013387ssl_c_key_alg : string
13388 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13389 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13390 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392ssl_c_notafter : string
13393 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13394 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13395 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013397ssl_c_notbefore : string
13398 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13399 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13400 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013402ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13403 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13404 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13405 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13406 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13407 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13408 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13409 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13410 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013412ssl_c_serial : binary
13413 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13414 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13415 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013417ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13418 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13419 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13420 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013421 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13422 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13423
13424 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13427 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13428 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13429 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431ssl_c_used : boolean
13432 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13433 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435ssl_c_verify : integer
13436 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13437 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13438 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13439 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441ssl_c_version : integer
13442 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13443 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013444
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013445ssl_f_der : binary
13446 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13447 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13448 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013450ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13451 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13452 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13453 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13454 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013455 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13457 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13458 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460ssl_f_key_alg : string
13461 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13462 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13463 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465ssl_f_notafter : string
13466 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13467 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13468 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470ssl_f_notbefore : string
13471 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13472 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13473 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013475ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13476 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13477 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13478 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13479 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13480 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13481 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13482 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13483 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013485ssl_f_serial : binary
13486 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13487 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13488 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013489
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013490ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13491 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13492 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13493 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013495ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13496 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13497 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13498 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013500ssl_f_version : integer
13501 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13502 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13503
13504ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013505 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13506 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13507 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013509 Example :
13510 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13511 listen http-https
13512 bind :80
13513 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13514 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13515
13516ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13517 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13518 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13519
13520ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013521 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013522 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13523 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13524 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13525 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13526 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13527 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13528 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13529 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531ssl_fc_cipher : string
13532 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13533 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013535ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013536 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13537 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013538 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13539 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13540 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13541 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13544 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013545 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13546 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13547 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13548 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013549
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013550ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013551 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13552 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013555 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013556 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13557 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13558 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13559 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13560 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13561 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13562 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013564ssl_fc_protocol : string
13565 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13566 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013567
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013568ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013569 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013570 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13571 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013573ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13574 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13575 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13576 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13577 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013579ssl_fc_sni : string
13580 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13581 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13582 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13583 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13584 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13585
13586 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13587 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13588 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013589 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13590 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013592 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013593 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13594 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013596ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13597 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13598 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013599
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013600
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136017.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013602------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013604Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13605sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13606only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13607For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13608be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13609can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13610sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13611for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13612content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013614payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13615 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13616 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13617 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013619payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13620 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13621 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13622 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624req.len : integer
13625req_len : integer (deprecated)
13626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13627 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13628 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13629 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13630 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13631 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13632 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13633 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13636 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013637 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13638 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13639 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13640 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013642 ACL alternatives :
13643 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13646 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13647 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13648 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13649 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651 ACL alternatives :
13652 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013654 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013656req.proto_http : boolean
13657req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13658 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13659 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13660 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13661 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13662 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13663 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13664 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666 Example:
13667 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13668 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13669 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013670 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013672req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13673rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13674 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13675 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13676 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13677 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13678 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13679 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13680 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013682 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13683 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13684 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13685 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13686 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13687 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013689 ACL derivatives :
13690 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013692 Example :
13693 listen tse-farm
13694 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13695 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13696 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13697 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13698 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13699 persist rdp-cookie
13700 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13701 # This is only useful makes sense if
13702 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13703 stick-table type string size 204800
13704 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13705 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13706 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013708 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13709 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013711req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13712rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13713 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13714 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13715 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13716 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013718 ACL derivatives :
13719 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013720
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013721req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13722 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13723 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013724 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13725 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13726 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13727 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13728 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013730req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13731req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13732 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13733 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13734 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13735 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13736 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13737 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13738 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013740req.ssl_sni : string
13741req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13742 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13743 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13744 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13745 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13746 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13747 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13748 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13749 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13750 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13751 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13752 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13753 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755 ACL derivatives :
13756 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013758 Examples :
13759 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13760 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13761 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13762 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13763 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013764
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013765req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13766 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13767 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13768 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13769 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13770 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13771 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13772 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13773 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13774 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013776req.ssl_ver : integer
13777req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13778 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13779 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13780 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13781 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13782 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13783 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13784 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13785 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13786 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013788 ACL derivatives :
13789 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013790
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013791res.len : integer
13792 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13793 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13794 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13795 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13796 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13797 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13798 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13799 content inspection.
13800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013801res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13802 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013803 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13804 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13805 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13806 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013808res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13809 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13810 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13811 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13812 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013814 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013815
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013816res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13817rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13818 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13819 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13820 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13821 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13822 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13823 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13824 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013826wait_end : boolean
13827 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13828 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13829 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13830 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13831 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13832 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13833 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13834 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013836 Examples :
13837 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13838 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13839 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013841 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13842 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13843 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13844 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13845 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13846 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13847 tcp-request content reject
13848
13849
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138507.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013851--------------------------------------
13852
13853It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13854This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13855data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13856its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13857HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13858content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13859to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13860more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13861response are indexed.
13862
13863base : string
13864 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13865 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13866 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13867 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13868 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13869 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13870 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13871 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13872
13873 ACL derivatives :
13874 base : exact string match
13875 base_beg : prefix match
13876 base_dir : subdir match
13877 base_dom : domain match
13878 base_end : suffix match
13879 base_len : length match
13880 base_reg : regex match
13881 base_sub : substring match
13882
13883base32 : integer
13884 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13885 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13886 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013887 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13888 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13889 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890
13891base32+src : binary
13892 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13893 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13894 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13895 per-URL counters.
13896
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013897capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13898 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13899 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13900 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13901
13902capture.req.method : string
13903 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13904 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13905 because it's allocated.
13906
13907capture.req.uri : string
13908 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13909 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13910 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13911 allocated.
13912
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013913capture.req.ver : string
13914 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13915 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13916 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13917
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013918capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13919 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13920 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13921 The first entry is an index of 0.
13922 See also: "capture response header"
13923
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013924capture.res.ver : string
13925 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13926 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13927 persistent flag.
13928
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013929req.body : binary
13930 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13931 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13932 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13933 the first chunk is analyzed.
13934
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013935req.body_param([<name>) : string
13936 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13937 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13938 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13939 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13940 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13941 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13942 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13943 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13944 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13945 given.
13946
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013947req.body_len : integer
13948 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13949 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13950 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13951 "option http-buffer-request".
13952
13953req.body_size : integer
13954 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13955 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13956 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13957 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13958 "option http-buffer-request".
13959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013960req.cook([<name>]) : string
13961cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13962 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13963 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13964 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13965 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13966 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13967 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13968 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13969 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13970
13971 ACL derivatives :
13972 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13973 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13974 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13975 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13976 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13977 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13978 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13979 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013981req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13982cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13983 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13984 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013986req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13987cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13988 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13989 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13990 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13991 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13994 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13995 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13996 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13997 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013998 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14000 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14001 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14002 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014004hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14005 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14006 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14007 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14008 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014009 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14012 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14013 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14014 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14015 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14016 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14017 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14018 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14019 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014021req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14022 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14023 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14024 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14025 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014027req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14028 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14029 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14030 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14031 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14032 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14033 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14034 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14035 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14036 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14037 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14038 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014040 ACL derivatives :
14041 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14042 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14043 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14044 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14045 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14046 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14047 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14048 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14049
14050req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14051hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14052 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14053 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14054 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14055 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14056 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14057 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14058 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14059 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14060 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14061
14062req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14063hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14064 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14065 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14066 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14067 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14068 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14069 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14070 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14071 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14072
14073req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14074hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14075 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14076 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14077 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14078 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14079 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14080 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14081 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14082
14083http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14084 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14085 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14086 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14087 basic auth is supported.
14088
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014089http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14090 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14091 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14092 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14093 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014094 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14095 basic auth is supported.
14096
14097 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014098 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14099 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14100 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14101 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014102
14103http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014104 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14105 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014106 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14107 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109method : integer + string
14110 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14111 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14112 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14113 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14114 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14115 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14116 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014118 ACL derivatives :
14119 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121 Example :
14122 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14123 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14124 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126path : string
14127 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14128 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14129 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14130 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14131 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14132 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14133 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135 ACL derivatives :
14136 path : exact string match
14137 path_beg : prefix match
14138 path_dir : subdir match
14139 path_dom : domain match
14140 path_end : suffix match
14141 path_len : length match
14142 path_reg : regex match
14143 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014144
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014145query : string
14146 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14147 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14148 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14149 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
14150 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
14151 which stops before the question mark.
14152
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014153req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14154 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14155 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14156 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14157 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014159req.ver : string
14160req_ver : string (deprecated)
14161 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14162 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14163 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014165 ACL derivatives :
14166 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168res.comp : boolean
14169 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14170 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14171 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014173res.comp_algo : string
14174 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14175 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14176 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014178res.cook([<name>]) : string
14179scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14180 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14181 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14182 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184 ACL derivatives :
14185 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014187res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14188scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14189 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14190 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14191 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14194scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14195 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14196 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14197 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014199res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14200 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14201 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14202 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14203 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14204 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14205 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14206 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14207 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14208 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14211 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14212 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14213 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14214 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14215 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014217res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14218shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14219 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14220 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14221 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14222 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14223 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14224 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14225 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14226 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014228 ACL derivatives :
14229 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14230 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14231 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14232 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14233 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14234 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14235 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14236 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14237
14238res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14239shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14240 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14241 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14242 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14243 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14244 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014246res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14247shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14248 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14249 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14250 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14251 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14252 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14253 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014254
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014255res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14256 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14257 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14258 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14259 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014261res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14262shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14263 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14264 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14265 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14266 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14267 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14268 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270res.ver : string
14271resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14272 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14273 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014275 ACL derivatives :
14276 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14279 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14280 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014281 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014284 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14285 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287status : integer
14288 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14289 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14290 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014291
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014292unique-id : string
14293 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14294 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14295 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14296 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14297 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14298 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014300url : string
14301 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14302 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14303 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14304 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14305 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14306 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14307 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014309 ACL derivatives :
14310 url : exact string match
14311 url_beg : prefix match
14312 url_dir : subdir match
14313 url_dom : domain match
14314 url_end : suffix match
14315 url_len : length match
14316 url_reg : regex match
14317 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014319url_ip : ip
14320 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14321 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14322 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14323 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14324 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14325 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14326 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328url_port : integer
14329 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14330 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14331 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14332 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014333
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014334urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14335url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014336 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14337 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014338 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14339 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14340 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14341 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014342 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14343 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014344 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14345 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014347 ACL derivatives :
14348 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14349 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14350 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14351 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14352 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14353 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14354 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14355 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014356
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358 Example :
14359 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14360 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14361 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14362 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014363
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014364urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14366 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14367 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014368
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014369url32 : integer
14370 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14371 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14372 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14373 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14374 is an unsigned integer.
14375
14376url32+src : binary
14377 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14378 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14379 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14380
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143827.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014383---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014385Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14386every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014387order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014389ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14390---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014391FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014392HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014393HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14394HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014395HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14396HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14397HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14398HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14399LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014400METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014401METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014402METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14403METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14404METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14405METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014406METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014407METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014408RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014409REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014410TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014411WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14412---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014413
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144158. Logging
14416----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014417
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014418One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14419provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14420very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14421provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14422state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014423to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014424headers.
14425
14426In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14427about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14428send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14429
14430 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14431 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14432 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14433 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14434 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014435 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14436 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014437
14438The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14439allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14440as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14441while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14442real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14443delay.
14444
14445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144468.1. Log levels
14447---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014448
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014449TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014450source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014451HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14452in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14453track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14454syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14455about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014456
14457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144588.2. Log formats
14459----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014460
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014461HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014462and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14463slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14464options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014465
14466 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14467 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14468 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14469 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14470 extents.
14471
14472 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14473 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14474 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14475 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14476 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14477
14478 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14479 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14480 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14481 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14482 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14483
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014484 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14485 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14486 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14487 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14488
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014489 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14490
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014491Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14492specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14493field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14494servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14495always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14496identifier.
14497
14498Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14499 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14500 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14501 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14502 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14503
14504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145058.2.1. Default log format
14506-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014507
14508This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14509as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14510format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14511
14512 Example :
14513 listen www
14514 mode http
14515 log global
14516 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14517
14518 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14519 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14520 (www/HTTP)
14521
14522 Field Format Extract from the example above
14523 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14524 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14525 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14526 4 'to' to
14527 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14528 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14529
14530Detailed fields description :
14531 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14532 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14533 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14534 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14535 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14536 and processed the connection.
14537 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14538
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014539In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14540"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14541connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14542
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014543It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14544will eventually disappear.
14545
14546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145478.2.2. TCP log format
14548---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014549
14550The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14551is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14552information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14553counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14554emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14555environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14556the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14557sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014558specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14559not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14560fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14561marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014562
14563 Example :
14564 frontend fnt
14565 mode tcp
14566 option tcplog
14567 log global
14568 default_backend bck
14569
14570 backend bck
14571 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14572
14573 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14574 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14575 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14576
14577 Field Format Extract from the example above
14578 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14579 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14580 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14581 4 frontend_name fnt
14582 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14583 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14584 7 bytes_read* 212
14585 8 termination_state --
14586 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14587 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14588
14589Detailed fields description :
14590 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014591 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14592 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14593 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014594 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14595 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14596 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014597
14598 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014599 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14600 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14601 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014602
14603 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14604 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14605 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14606 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14607
14608 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14609 and processed the connection.
14610
14611 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14612 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14613 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14614 applications.
14615
14616 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14617 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14618 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14619 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14620 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14621
14622 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14623 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14624 See "Timers" below for more details.
14625
14626 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14627 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14628 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14629 "Timers" below for more details.
14630
14631 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014632 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014633 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14634 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14635 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14636 details.
14637
14638 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14639 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14640 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14641 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14642 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14643
14644 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14645 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14646 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14647 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14648 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14649 for more details.
14650
14651 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014652 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014653 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14654 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14655 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014656 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014657
14658 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14659 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14660 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14661 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14662 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14663 caused by a denial of service attack.
14664
14665 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14666 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14667 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14668 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14669 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14670 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14671 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14672 denial of service attack.
14673
14674 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14675 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14676 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14677 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14678 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14679 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14680 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14681 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14682 be processed than on other servers.
14683
14684 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14685 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14686 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14687 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14688 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14689 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14690 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14691 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14692 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14693 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14694 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14695 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14696 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14697
14698 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14699 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14700 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14701 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14702 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14703 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14704 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14705 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14706
14707 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14708 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14709 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14710 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14711 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14712 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14713 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14714 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14715 occurs.
14716
14717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147188.2.3. HTTP log format
14719----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014720
14721The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14722is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14723the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14724are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14725emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14726generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14727"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14728which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014729frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14730is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014731
14732Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14733slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14734with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14735
14736 Example :
14737 frontend http-in
14738 mode http
14739 option httplog
14740 log global
14741 default_backend bck
14742
14743 backend static
14744 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14745
14746 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14747 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14748 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014749 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014750
14751 Field Format Extract from the example above
14752 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14753 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014754 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014755 4 frontend_name http-in
14756 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014757 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014758 7 status_code 200
14759 8 bytes_read* 2750
14760 9 captured_request_cookie -
14761 10 captured_response_cookie -
14762 11 termination_state ----
14763 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14764 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14765 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14766 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14767 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014768
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014769Detailed fields description :
14770 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014771 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14772 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14773 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014774 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14775 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14776 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014777
14778 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014779 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14780 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14781 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014782
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014783 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
14784 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014785
14786 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14787 and processed the connection.
14788
14789 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14790 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14791 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14792
14793 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14794 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14795 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14796 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14797 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14798 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14799
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014800 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
14801 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
14802 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
14803 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
14804 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
14805 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
14806 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014807
14808 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14809 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14810 See "Timers" below for more details.
14811
14812 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14813 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14814 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14815 below for more details.
14816
14817 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14818 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14819 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14820 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14821 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14822 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14823 for more details.
14824
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014825 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
14826 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
14827 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
14828 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
14829 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
14830 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
14831 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
14832 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014833
14834 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14835 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14836 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14837
14838 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14839 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14840 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14841 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14842 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14843 overflowing.
14844
14845 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14846 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14847 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14848 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14849 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14850 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14851 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14852 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14853
14854 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14855 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14856 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14857 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14858 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14859 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14860 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14861 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14862
14863 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14864 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14865 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14866 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14867 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14868 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14869 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14870
14871 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014872 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014873 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14874 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14875 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014876 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014877 system.
14878
14879 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14880 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14881 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14882 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14883 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14884 caused by a denial of service attack.
14885
14886 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14887 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14888 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14889 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14890 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14891 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14892 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14893 denial of service attack.
14894
14895 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14896 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14897 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14898 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14899 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14900 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14901 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14902 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14903 processed than on other servers.
14904
14905 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14906 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14907 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14908 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14909 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14910 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14911 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14912 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14913 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14914 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14915 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14916 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14917 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14918
14919 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14920 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14921 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14922 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14923 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14924 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14925 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14926 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14927
14928 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14929 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14930 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14931 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14932 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14933 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14934 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14935 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14936 occurs.
14937
14938 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14939 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14940 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14941 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14942 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14943 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14944 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14945 cookies" below for more details.
14946
14947 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14948 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14949 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14950 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14951 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14952 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14953 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14954 and cookies" below for more details.
14955
14956 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14957 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14958 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14959 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14960 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14961 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14962 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14963 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14964
14965
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200149668.2.4. Custom log format
14967------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014968
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014969The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014970mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014971
14972HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14973Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14974separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14975prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14976
14977Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14978variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014979("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014980
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014981If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014982as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014983less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14984the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14985
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014986Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014987In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014988in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014989
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014990Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14991'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14992https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14993such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14994
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014995Flags are :
14996 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014997 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014998 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14999 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015000
15001 Example:
15002
15003 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15004 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15005
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015006 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15007
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015008At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15009
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015010 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15011 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015012
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015013the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015014
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015015 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15016 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15017 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015018
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015019and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15020
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015021 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15022 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015023
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015024Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15025
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015026 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015027 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015028 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15029 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15030 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015031 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15032 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15033 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015034 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015035 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15036 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015037 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015038 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15039 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015040 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015041 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015042 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015043 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015044 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015045 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015046 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015047 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15048 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15049 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15050 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15051 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015052 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015053 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15054 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015055 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015056 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15057 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015058 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15059 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15060 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015061 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015062 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15063 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015064 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015065 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15066 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15067 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015068 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015069 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015070 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15071 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15072 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15073 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015074 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015075 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015076 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015077 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015078 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015079 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015080 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15081 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15082 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015083 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015084 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15085 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015086 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015087 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15088 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15089 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015090 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015091 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015092 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015093
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015094 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015095
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015096
150978.2.5. Error log format
15098-----------------------
15099
15100When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15101protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15102By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15103"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15104will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15105logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15106
15107The format looks like this :
15108
15109 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15110 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15111 Connection error during SSL handshake
15112
15113 Field Format Extract from the example above
15114 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15115 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15116 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15117 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15118 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15119
15120These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15121failures.
15122
15123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151248.3. Advanced logging options
15125-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015126
15127Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15128just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15129options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15130for more information about their usage.
15131
15132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151338.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15134------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015135
15136It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15137haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15138commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15139monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15140ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15141
15142 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15143 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15144 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15145 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15146
15147 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15148 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15149 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015150 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015151 such as other load-balancers.
15152
15153 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15154 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15155 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15156
15157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151588.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15159----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015160
15161The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15162what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15163or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15164"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15165just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15166log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15167after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15168is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15169with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15170with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15171
15172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151738.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15174------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015175
15176Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15177for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15178"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15179retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15180raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15181a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15182file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15183you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15184"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15185
15186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15188--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015189
15190Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15191multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15192them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15193"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15194logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15195error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15196and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15197too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15198useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15199alternative.
15200
15201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152028.4. Timing events
15203------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015204
15205Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15206reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15207the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15208frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015209mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15210addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15211
15212 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15213 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15214 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15215 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15216 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15217 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15218 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015219
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015220 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15221 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15222 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15223 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15224 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15225 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15226 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15227 nothing was received on the connection.
15228
15229 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15230 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15231 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15232 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15233 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15234 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15235 request typed by hand during a test.
15236
15237 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15238 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15239 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15240 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15241 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15242 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15243 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015244
15245 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15246 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15247 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15248 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15249 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15250
15251 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15252 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15253 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15254 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15255 connection never established.
15256
15257 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15258 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15259 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15260 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15261 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15262 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15263 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15264 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15265 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15266 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15267 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15268
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015269 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15270 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15271 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15272 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15273 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15274 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15275
15276 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15277
15278 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15279 "Ta" can never be negative.
15280
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015281 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15282 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015283 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15284 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015285 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015286
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015287 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015288
15289 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015290 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15291 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015292
15293These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15294protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15295that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015296due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15297"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15298that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015299
15300Most common cases :
15301
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015302 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15303 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15304 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15305 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15306 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15307 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15308 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15309 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15310 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15311 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15312 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015313 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015314
15315 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15316 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15317 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15318 of ms on remote networks.
15319
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015320 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15321 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15322 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015323
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015324 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15325 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15326 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15327 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15328 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15329 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15330 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15331 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15332 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015333
15334Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15335
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015336 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015337 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015338 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015339
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015340 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015341 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15342 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15343
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015344 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015345 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15346 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15347 flags.
15348
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015349 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15350 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015351 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15352 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15353 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15354 the client connection was maintained open.
15355
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015356 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015357 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015358 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015359 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15360
15361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153628.5. Session state at disconnection
15363-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015364
15365TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15366"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
153672-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15368each of which has a special meaning :
15369
15370 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15371 session to terminate :
15372
15373 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15374
15375 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15376 server explicitly refused it.
15377
15378 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15379 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15380 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15381 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015382 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15383
15384 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15385 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015386
15387 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15388 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15389 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15390 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15391 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15392
15393 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15394 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15395 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15396 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15397 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15398
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015399 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15400 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15401
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015402 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15403 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15404 backup connections when going up.
15405
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015406 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15407
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015408 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15409 send or receive data.
15410
15411 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15412 send or receive data.
15413
15414 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15415 with nothing left in the buffers.
15416
15417 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15418
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015419 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015420 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15421
15422 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15423 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15424 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15425 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15426 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15427
15428 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15429 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15430
15431 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15432 server (HTTP only).
15433
15434 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15435
15436 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15437 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15438 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15439
15440 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15441 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15442 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15443
15444 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15445
15446 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15447 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15448
15449 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15450 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15451 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15452
15453 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15454 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015455 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15456 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015457
15458 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15459 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15460 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15461 another server.
15462
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015463 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015464 server.
15465
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015466 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15467 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15468 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15469 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15470
15471 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15472 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15473 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15474 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15475
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015476 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15477 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15478 "use-server" rule).
15479
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015480 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15481
15482 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15483 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15484
15485 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15486
15487 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15488 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15489 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15490
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015491 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15492 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015493 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015494 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15495 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15496
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015497 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15498
15499 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15500 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15501
15502 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15503
15504 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15505
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015506The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15507was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015508helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15509starvation, attacks, etc...
15510
15511The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15512alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15513easier finding and understanding.
15514
15515 Flags Reason
15516
15517 -- Normal termination.
15518
15519 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15520 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15521 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15522 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15523
15524 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15525 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15526 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15527 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15528 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15529 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015530
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015531 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15532 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015533 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015534
15535 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15536 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15537 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15538
15539 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15540 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15541 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15542 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15543 the server takes too long to respond.
15544
15545 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15546 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15547 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15548 long a time to respond.
15549
15550 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15551 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15552 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15553 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015554 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15555 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015556
15557 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15558 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15559 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15560 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15561 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015562 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015563 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15564 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15565 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15566 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15567 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15568 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15569 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15570 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15571 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15572 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15573 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15574 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015575
15576 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15577 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015578 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15579 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15580 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15581 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015582
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015583 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15584 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015586 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015587 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15588 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15589 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15590 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15591 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15592
15593 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15594 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15595 503 or 504 here.
15596
15597 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15598 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15599 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15600 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15601 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15602
15603 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15604 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015605 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015606 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15607 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15608
15609 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15610 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15611 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15612 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15613 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15614 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15615 between haproxy and the server.
15616
15617 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15618 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15619 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15620 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15621 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15622 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15623 solution is to fix the application.
15624
15625 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15626 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15627 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15628 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15629 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15630 external attacks.
15631
15632 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15633 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015634 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015635 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15636 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15637
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015638 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15639 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15640 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015641 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15642 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015643
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015644 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15645 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15646 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15647 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015648 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15649 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15650 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15651 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15652 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015653
15654 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15655 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15656 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15657 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15658
15659 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15660 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15661 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15662 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15663
15664 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15665 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15666 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15667 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15668
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015669The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15670persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15671important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15672re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15673
15674 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15675
15676 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15677 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15678 set on a GET request.
15679
15680 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15681 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015682 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015683 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15684
15685 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15686 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15687 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15688
15689 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15690 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15691 already got a cookie.
15692
15693 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15694 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15695 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15696 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15697 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15698
15699 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15700 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15701 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15702
15703 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15704 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15705 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15706
15707 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15708 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15709
15710 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15711 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15712 then advertised in the response.
15713
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157158.6. Non-printable characters
15716-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015717
15718In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15719consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15720converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15721prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15722being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15723escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15724is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15725'}' when logging headers.
15726
15727Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15728issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15729containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15730
15731Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15732the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15733performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15734
15735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157368.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15737---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015738
15739Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15740achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015741section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015742cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15743the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15744the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015745locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015746not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15747user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15748a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15749wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15750
15751 Examples :
15752 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15753 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15754
15755 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15756 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15757
15758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157598.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15760---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015761
15762Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15763proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15764the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15765server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15766
15767Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15768response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015769section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015770
15771It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015772time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15773appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015774are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15775and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15776follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15777request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15778in the logs.
15779
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015780As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15781frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15782an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15783
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015784 Example :
15785 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15786 listen proxy-out
15787 mode http
15788 option httplog
15789 option logasap
15790 log global
15791 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15792
15793 # log the name of the virtual server
15794 capture request header Host len 20
15795
15796 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15797 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15798
15799 # log the beginning of the referrer
15800 capture request header Referer len 20
15801
15802 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15803 capture response header Server len 20
15804
15805 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15806 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15807
15808 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15809 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15810
15811 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15812 capture response header Via len 20
15813
15814 # log the URL location during a redirection
15815 capture response header Location len 20
15816
15817 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15818 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15819 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15820 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15821 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15822
15823 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15824 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15825 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15826 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015827 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015828
15829 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15830 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15831 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15832 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15833 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015834 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015835
15836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158378.9. Examples of logs
15838---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015839
15840These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15841them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15842reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15843
15844 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15845 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15846 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15847
15848 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15849 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15850
15851 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15852 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15853 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15854
15855 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15856 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15857
15858 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15859 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15860 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15861
15862 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015863 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015864 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15865 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15866
15867 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15868 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15869 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15870
15871 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15872 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015873 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015874 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15875 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15876 to return the 502 and not the server.
15877
15878 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015879 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015880
15881 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15882 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15883 Nothing was sent to any server.
15884
15885 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15886 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15887
15888 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15889 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15890 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15891 send a 408 return code to the client.
15892
15893 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15894 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15895
15896 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15897 5 seconds ("c----").
15898
15899 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15900 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015901 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015902
15903 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015904 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015905 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15906 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15907 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15908 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15909 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015910
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015911
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200159129. Supported filters
15913--------------------
15914
15915Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15916accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15917unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15918
15919See also : "filter"
15920
159219.1. Trace
15922----------
15923
15924filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15925
15926 Arguments:
15927 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15928 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15929
15930 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15931 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15932 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15933 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15934
15935 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15936 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15937 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15938 amount of the parsed data.
15939
15940This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15941callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15942information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15943filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15944
15945Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15946tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15947a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15948
15949
159509.2. HTTP compression
15951---------------------
15952
15953filter compression
15954
15955The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15956keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15957when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15958use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15959used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15960filters evaluation order.
15961
15962See also : "compression"
15963
15964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015965/*
15966 * Local variables:
15967 * fill-column: 79
15968 * End:
15969 */